2009-12-17 Stan Shebs <stan@codesourcery.com>
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
131
132 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
133
134 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
135
136 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
137
138 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
139
140 static void commands_command (char *, int);
141
142 static void condition_command (char *, int);
143
144 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
145
146 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
147
148 typedef enum
149 {
150 mark_inserted,
151 mark_uninserted
152 }
153 insertion_state_t;
154
155 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
157
158 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
159
160 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
161
162 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
163
164 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
165
166 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
167
168 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
169
170 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
171
172 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
173
174 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
175
176 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
177
178 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
179
180 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
181
182 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
183
184 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
185
186 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
189
190 static char *ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg);
191
192 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
193 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
194
195 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
196
197 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
198
199 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
200 CORE_ADDR pc);
201
202 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
203
204 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
205
206 static void update_global_location_list (int);
207
208 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
209
210 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
211
212 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
213
214 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
215
216 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
217
218 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
219
220 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
221
222 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
223
224 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
225
226 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
227
228
229 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
230 current breakpoint. */
231
232 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
233
234 static const char *
235 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
236 {
237 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
238 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
239 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
240 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
241 }
242
243 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
244 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
245 if such is available. */
246 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
247
248 static void
249 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
250 struct cmd_list_element *c,
251 const char *value)
252 {
253 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
254 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
255 value);
256 }
257
258 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
259 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
260 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
261 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
262 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
263 static void
264 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
265 struct cmd_list_element *c,
266 const char *value)
267 {
268 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
269 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
270 value);
271 }
272
273 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
274 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
275 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
276 use hardware breakpoints. */
277 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
278 static void
279 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
280 struct cmd_list_element *c,
281 const char *value)
282 {
283 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
284 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
285 value);
286 }
287
288 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
289 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
290 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
291 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
292 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
293
294 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
295 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
296 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
297 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
298 always_inserted_auto,
299 always_inserted_off,
300 always_inserted_on,
301 NULL
302 };
303 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
304 static void
305 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
306 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
307 {
308 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
309 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
310 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
311 value,
312 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
313 else
314 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
315 }
316
317 int
318 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
319 {
320 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
321 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
322 }
323
324 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
325
326 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
327 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
328
329 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
330 static int overlay_events_enabled;
331
332 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
333 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
334 breakpoint. */
335
336 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
337
338 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
339 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
340 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
341 B = TMP)
342
343 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
344 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
345 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
346
347 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
348 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
349 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
350 BP_TMP++)
351
352 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
353
354 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
355 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
356 if ((B)->type == bp_tracepoint)
357
358 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
359
360 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
361
362 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
363
364 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
365
366 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
367
368 static unsigned bp_location_count;
369
370 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
371 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
372 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
373 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
374
375 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
376
377 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
378 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
379 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
380 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
381 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
382
383 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
384
385 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
386 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
387 may still be reported by a target. */
388 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
389
390 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
391
392 int breakpoint_count;
393
394 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
395
396 int tracepoint_count;
397
398 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
399 static int
400 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
401 {
402 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
403 }
404
405 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
406
407 void
408 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
409 {
410 breakpoint_count = num;
411 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
412 }
413
414 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
415
416 void
417 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
418 {
419 struct breakpoint *b;
420
421 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
422 b->hit_count = 0;
423 }
424
425 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
426 for "break" command with no arg.
427 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
428 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
429
430 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
431
432 int default_breakpoint_valid;
433 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
434 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
435 int default_breakpoint_line;
436 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
437
438 \f
439 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
440 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
441
442 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
443 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
444 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
445
446 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
447
448 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
449 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
450 static int
451 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
452 {
453 int retval = 0; /* default */
454 char *p = *pp;
455
456 if (p == NULL)
457 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
458 return breakpoint_count;
459 else if (*p == '$')
460 {
461 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
462 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
463 char *varname;
464 char *start = ++p;
465 LONGEST val;
466
467 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
468 p++;
469 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
470 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
471 varname[p - start] = '\0';
472 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
473 retval = (int) val;
474 else
475 {
476 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
477 retval = 0;
478 }
479 }
480 else
481 {
482 if (*p == '-')
483 ++p;
484 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
485 ++p;
486 if (p == *pp)
487 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
488 {
489 /* Skip non-numeric token */
490 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
491 ++p;
492 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
493 retval = 0;
494 }
495 else
496 retval = atoi (*pp);
497 }
498 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
499 {
500 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
501 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
502 ++p;
503 retval = 0;
504 }
505 while (isspace (*p))
506 p++;
507 *pp = p;
508 return retval;
509 }
510
511
512 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
513 int
514 get_number (char **pp)
515 {
516 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
517 }
518
519 /* Parse a number or a range.
520 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
521 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
522 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
523 * inclusive.
524 *
525 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
526 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
527 *
528 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
529 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
530 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
531 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
532 * pointer PP past <number2>.
533 */
534
535 int
536 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
537 {
538 static int last_retval, end_value;
539 static char *end_ptr;
540 static int in_range = 0;
541
542 if (**pp != '-')
543 {
544 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
545 or to the first number of a range. */
546 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
547 if (**pp == '-')
548 {
549 char **temp;
550
551 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
552 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
553 and also remember the end of the final token. */
554
555 temp = &end_ptr;
556 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
557 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
558 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
559 end_value = get_number (temp);
560 if (end_value < last_retval)
561 {
562 error (_("inverted range"));
563 }
564 else if (end_value == last_retval)
565 {
566 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
567 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
568 single number. */
569 *pp = end_ptr;
570 }
571 else
572 in_range = 1;
573 }
574 }
575 else if (! in_range)
576 error (_("negative value"));
577 else
578 {
579 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
580 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
581 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
582 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
583 is reached. */
584
585 if (++last_retval == end_value)
586 {
587 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
588 *pp = end_ptr;
589 in_range = 0;
590 }
591 }
592 return last_retval;
593 }
594
595 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
596 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
597
598 struct breakpoint *
599 get_breakpoint (int num)
600 {
601 struct breakpoint *b;
602
603 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
604 if (b->number == num)
605 return b;
606
607 return NULL;
608 }
609
610 \f
611 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
612
613 static void
614 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
615 {
616 struct breakpoint *b;
617 char *p;
618 int bnum;
619
620 if (arg == 0)
621 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
622
623 p = arg;
624 bnum = get_number (&p);
625 if (bnum == 0)
626 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
627
628 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
629 if (b->number == bnum)
630 {
631 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
632 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
633 {
634 if (loc->cond)
635 {
636 xfree (loc->cond);
637 loc->cond = 0;
638 }
639 }
640 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
641 xfree (b->cond_string);
642
643 if (*p == 0)
644 {
645 b->cond_string = NULL;
646 if (from_tty)
647 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
648 }
649 else
650 {
651 arg = p;
652 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
653 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
654 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
655 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
656 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
657 {
658 arg = p;
659 loc->cond =
660 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
661 if (*arg)
662 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
663 }
664 }
665 breakpoints_changed ();
666 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
667 return;
668 }
669
670 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
671 }
672
673 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
674
675 void
676 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
677 {
678 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
679 b->commands = commands;
680 breakpoints_changed ();
681 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
682 }
683
684 static void
685 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
686 {
687 struct breakpoint *b;
688 char *p;
689 int bnum;
690 struct command_line *l;
691
692 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
693 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
694 being read from. */
695
696 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
697 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
698
699 p = arg;
700 bnum = get_number (&p);
701
702 if (p && *p)
703 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
704
705 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
706 if (b->number == bnum)
707 {
708 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
709 bnum);
710 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
711 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
712 do_cleanups (cleanups);
713 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
714 return;
715 }
716 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
717 }
718
719 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
720 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
721
722 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
723 that are part of if and while bodies. */
724 enum command_control_type
725 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
726 {
727 struct breakpoint *b;
728 char *p;
729 int bnum;
730
731 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
732 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
733 being read from. */
734
735 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
736 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
737
738 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
739 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
740 if (arg && !*arg)
741 p = NULL;
742 else
743 p = arg;
744 bnum = get_number (&p);
745
746 if (p && *p)
747 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
748
749 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
750 if (b->number == bnum)
751 {
752 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
753 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
754 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
755 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
756 list after it finishes execution. */
757 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
758 breakpoints_changed ();
759 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
760 return simple_control;
761 }
762 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
763 }
764
765 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
766
767 static int
768 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
769 {
770 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
771 return 0;
772 if (!bl->inserted)
773 return 0;
774 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
775 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
776 return 0;
777 return 1;
778 }
779
780 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
781 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
782
783 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
784 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
785 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
786 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
787 memaddr ... memaddr + len
788 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
789 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
790 and:
791 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
792
793 void
794 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
795 {
796 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
797 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
798
799 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
800 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
801
802 bc_l = 0;
803 bc_r = bp_location_count;
804 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
805 {
806 struct bp_location *b;
807
808 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
809 b = bp_location[bc];
810
811 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
812 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
813 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
814
815 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
816 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
817 MEMADDR. */
818
819 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
820 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
821 bc_l = bc;
822 else
823 bc_r = bc;
824 }
825
826 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
827
828 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
829 {
830 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
831 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
832 int bp_size = 0;
833 int bptoffset = 0;
834
835 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
836 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
837 b->owner->number);
838
839 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
840 content. */
841
842 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
843 && memaddr + len <= b->address
844 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
845 break;
846
847 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
848 continue;
849 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
850 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
851 continue;
852
853 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
854 we need to copy. */
855 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
856 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
857
858 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
859 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
860 are reading. */
861 continue;
862
863 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
864 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
865 reading. */
866 continue;
867
868 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
869 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
870 {
871 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
872 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
873 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
874 bp_addr = memaddr;
875 }
876
877 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
878 {
879 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
880 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
881 }
882
883 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
884 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
885 }
886 }
887 \f
888
889 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
890 static void
891 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
892 {
893 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
894 int val = -1;
895
896 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
897 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
898
899 b->ops->insert (b);
900 }
901
902 static int
903 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
904 {
905 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
906 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
907 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
908 }
909
910 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
911 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
912 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
913 not need them.
914
915 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
916 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
917 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
918 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
919 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
920
921 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
922 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
923 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
924 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
925
926 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
927 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
928 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
929 chain. */
930
931 static void
932 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
933 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
934 {
935 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
936 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
937
938 *valp = NULL;
939 if (resultp)
940 *resultp = NULL;
941 if (val_chain)
942 *val_chain = NULL;
943
944 /* Evaluate the expression. */
945 mark = value_mark ();
946 result = NULL;
947
948 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
949 {
950 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
951 }
952 if (ex.reason < 0)
953 {
954 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
955 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
956 error to some higher catcher. */
957 switch (ex.error)
958 {
959 case MEMORY_ERROR:
960 break;
961 default:
962 throw_exception (ex);
963 break;
964 }
965 }
966
967 new_mark = value_mark ();
968 if (mark == new_mark)
969 return;
970 if (resultp)
971 *resultp = result;
972
973 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
974 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
975 if (result != NULL
976 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
977 *valp = result;
978
979 if (val_chain)
980 {
981 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
982 decide which addresses to watch. */
983 *val_chain = new_mark;
984 value_release_to_mark (mark);
985 }
986 }
987
988 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
989 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
990 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
991 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
992 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
993 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
994 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
995 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
996 running. */
997
998 static int
999 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1000 {
1001 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1002 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1003 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1004 }
1005
1006 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1007 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1008 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1009 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1010 in b->loc->cond.
1011 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1012
1013 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1014 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1015
1016 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1017 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1018 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1019 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1020 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1021 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1022 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1023
1024 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1025 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1026 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1027 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1028 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1029 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1030 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1031 memory content has not changed.
1032
1033 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1034 watchpoints:
1035
1036 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1037 several times when GDB stops.
1038
1039 [linux]
1040 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1041 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1042 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1043 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1044 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1045 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1046 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1047 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1048 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1049 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1050
1051 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1052 removal from inferior. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1056 {
1057 int within_current_scope;
1058 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1059 struct bp_location *loc;
1060 int frame_saved;
1061 bpstat bs;
1062
1063 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1064 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1065 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1066 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1067 return;
1068
1069 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1070 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1071 breakpoints if needed. */
1072 b->loc = NULL;
1073
1074 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1075 return;
1076
1077 frame_saved = 0;
1078
1079 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1080 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1081 within_current_scope = 1;
1082 else
1083 {
1084 struct frame_info *fi;
1085
1086 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1087 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1088 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1089 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1090 selected frame. */
1091 frame_saved = 1;
1092 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1093
1094 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1095 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1096 if (within_current_scope)
1097 select_frame (fi);
1098 }
1099
1100 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1101 {
1102 char *s;
1103 if (b->exp)
1104 {
1105 xfree (b->exp);
1106 b->exp = NULL;
1107 }
1108 s = b->exp_string;
1109 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1110 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1111 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1112 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1113 be completely different objects. */
1114 value_free (b->val);
1115 b->val = NULL;
1116 b->val_valid = 0;
1117 }
1118
1119 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1120 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1121 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1122 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1123 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1124 if ( !target_has_execution)
1125 {
1126 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1127 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1128 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1129 }
1130 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1131 {
1132 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1133 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1134
1135 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1136
1137 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1138 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1139 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1140 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1141 if (!b->val_valid)
1142 {
1143 b->val = v;
1144 b->val_valid = 1;
1145 }
1146
1147 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1148 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1149 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1150 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1151 && reparse)
1152 {
1153 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1154
1155 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1156 &other_type_used);
1157 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1158
1159 if (!mem_cnt)
1160 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1161 else
1162 {
1163 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1164 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1165 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1166 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1167 else
1168 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1169 }
1170 }
1171
1172 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1173
1174 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1175 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1176 {
1177 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1178 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1179 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1180 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1181 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1182 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1183 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1184 {
1185 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1186
1187 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1188 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1189 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1190 if (v == result
1191 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1192 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1193 {
1194 CORE_ADDR addr;
1195 int len, type;
1196 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1197
1198 addr = value_address (v);
1199 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1200 type = hw_write;
1201 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1202 type = hw_read;
1203 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1204 type = hw_access;
1205
1206 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1207 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1208 ;
1209 *tmp = loc;
1210 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1211
1212 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1213 loc->address = addr;
1214 loc->length = len;
1215 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1216 }
1217 }
1218
1219 next = value_next (v);
1220 if (v != b->val)
1221 value_free (v);
1222 }
1223
1224 /* We just regenerated the list of breakpoint locations.
1225 The new location does not have its condition field set to anything
1226 and therefore, we must always reparse the cond_string, independently
1227 of the value of the reparse flag. */
1228 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1229 {
1230 char *s = b->cond_string;
1231 b->loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1232 }
1233 }
1234 else if (!within_current_scope)
1235 {
1236 printf_filtered (_("\
1237 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1238 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1239 b->number);
1240 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1241 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1242 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1246 if (frame_saved)
1247 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1248 }
1249
1250
1251 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1252 inserted in the inferior. */
1253 static int
1254 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1255 {
1256 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1257 return 0;
1258
1259 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1260 return 0;
1261
1262 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1263 return 0;
1264
1265 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1266 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1267 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1268 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1269 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1270 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1271 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1272 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1273 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1274 return 0;
1275
1276 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1277 not by us. */
1278 if (bpt->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
1279 return 0;
1280
1281 return 1;
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1285 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1286 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1287
1288 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1289 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1290 static int
1291 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1292 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1293 int *disabled_breaks,
1294 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1295 {
1296 int val = 0;
1297
1298 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1299 return 0;
1300
1301 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1302 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1303 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1304 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1305
1306 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1307 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1308 {
1309 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1310 {
1311 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1312 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1313 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1314 Two important cases are:
1315 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1316 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1317 hardware breakpoint.
1318 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1319 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1320 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1321
1322 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1323 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1324 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1325 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1326 struct mem_region *mr
1327 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1328
1329 if (mr)
1330 {
1331 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1332 {
1333 int changed = 0;
1334 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1335
1336 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1337 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1338 else
1339 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1340
1341 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1342 {
1343 static int said = 0;
1344 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1345 if (!said)
1346 {
1347 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1348 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1349 said = 1;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
1353 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1354 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1355 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1356 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1357 }
1358 }
1359
1360 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1361 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1362 || bpt->section == NULL
1363 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1364 {
1365 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1366
1367 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1368 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1369 &bpt->target_info);
1370 else
1371 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1372 &bpt->target_info);
1373 }
1374 else
1375 {
1376 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1377 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1378 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1379 {
1380 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1381 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1382 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1383 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1384 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1385 bpt->owner->number);
1386 else
1387 {
1388 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1389 bpt->section);
1390 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1391 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1392 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1393 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1394 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1395 if (val != 0)
1396 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1397 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1398 bpt->owner->number);
1399 }
1400 }
1401 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1402 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1403 {
1404 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1405 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1406 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1407 &bpt->target_info);
1408 else
1409 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1410 &bpt->target_info);
1411 }
1412 else
1413 {
1414 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1415 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1416 return 0;
1417 }
1418 }
1419
1420 if (val)
1421 {
1422 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1423 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1424 {
1425 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1426 val = 0;
1427 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1428 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1429 {
1430 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1431 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1432 bpt->owner->number);
1433 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1434 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1435 }
1436 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1437 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1438 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1439 }
1440 else
1441 {
1442 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1443 {
1444 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1445 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1446 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1447 bpt->owner->number);
1448 }
1449 else
1450 {
1451 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1452 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1453 bpt->owner->number);
1454 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1455 "Error accessing memory address ");
1456 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1457 tmp_error_stream);
1458 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1459 safe_strerror (val));
1460 }
1461
1462 }
1463 }
1464 else
1465 bpt->inserted = 1;
1466
1467 return val;
1468 }
1469
1470 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1471 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1472 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1473 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1474 {
1475 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1476 bpt->length,
1477 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1478 bpt->inserted = (val != -1);
1479 }
1480
1481 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1482 {
1483 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1484 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1485 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1486 bpt->owner->number);
1487 if (e.reason < 0)
1488 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1489 else
1490 bpt->inserted = 1;
1491
1492 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1493 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1494 so just return success. */
1495 return 0;
1496 }
1497
1498 return 0;
1499 }
1500
1501 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1502 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1503 PSPACE anymore. */
1504
1505 void
1506 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1507 {
1508 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1509 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1510
1511 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1512 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1513 {
1514 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1515 delete_breakpoint (b);
1516 }
1517
1518 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1519 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1520 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1521 {
1522 struct bp_location *tmp;
1523
1524 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1525 {
1526 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1527 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1528 else
1529 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1530 if (tmp->next == loc)
1531 {
1532 tmp->next = loc->next;
1533 break;
1534 }
1535 }
1536 }
1537
1538 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1539 removed locations above. */
1540 update_global_location_list (0);
1541 }
1542
1543 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1544 Throws exception on any error.
1545 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1546 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1547 void
1548 insert_breakpoints (void)
1549 {
1550 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1551
1552 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1553 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1554 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1555
1556 update_global_location_list (1);
1557
1558 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1559 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1560 now. */
1561 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1562 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1563 }
1564
1565 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1566 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1567 Both return zero if successful,
1568 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1569
1570 static void
1571 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1572 {
1573 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1574 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1575 int error = 0;
1576 int val = 0;
1577 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1578 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1579
1580 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1581 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1582
1583 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1584 there was an error. */
1585 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1586
1587 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1588
1589 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1590 {
1591 struct thread_info *tp;
1592 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1593
1594 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1595 continue;
1596
1597 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1598 thread no longer exists. */
1599 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1600 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1601 continue;
1602
1603 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1604
1605 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1606 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1607 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1608 insert breakpoints. */
1609 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1610 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1611 continue;
1612
1613 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1614 &disabled_breaks,
1615 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1616 if (val)
1617 error = val;
1618 }
1619
1620 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1621 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1622 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1623 {
1624 int some_failed = 0;
1625 struct bp_location *loc;
1626
1627 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1628 continue;
1629
1630 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1631 continue;
1632
1633 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1634 continue;
1635
1636 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1637 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1638 {
1639 some_failed = 1;
1640 break;
1641 }
1642 if (some_failed)
1643 {
1644 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1645 if (loc->inserted)
1646 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1647
1648 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1649 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1650 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1651 bpt->number);
1652 error = -1;
1653 }
1654 }
1655
1656 if (error)
1657 {
1658 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1659 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1660 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1661 {
1662 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1663 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1664 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1665 }
1666 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1667 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1668 }
1669
1670 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1671 }
1672
1673 int
1674 remove_breakpoints (void)
1675 {
1676 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1677 int val = 0;
1678
1679 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1680 {
1681 if (b->inserted)
1682 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1683 }
1684 return val;
1685 }
1686
1687 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1688
1689 int
1690 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1691 {
1692 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1693 int val;
1694 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1695
1696 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1697 {
1698 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1699 continue;
1700
1701 if (b->inserted)
1702 {
1703 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1704 if (val != 0)
1705 return val;
1706 }
1707 }
1708 return 0;
1709 }
1710
1711 int
1712 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1713 {
1714 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1715 int val = 0;
1716
1717 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1718 {
1719 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1720 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1721 }
1722 return val;
1723 }
1724
1725 int
1726 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1727 {
1728 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1729 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1730 int val;
1731 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1732 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1733 struct inferior *inf;
1734 struct thread_info *tp;
1735
1736 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1737 if (tp == NULL)
1738 return 1;
1739
1740 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1741 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1742
1743 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1744
1745 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1746
1747 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1748 {
1749 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1750 continue;
1751
1752 if (b->inserted)
1753 {
1754 b->inserted = 0;
1755 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1756 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1757 if (val != 0)
1758 {
1759 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1760 return val;
1761 }
1762 }
1763 }
1764 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1765 return 0;
1766 }
1767
1768 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1769
1770 static struct breakpoint *
1771 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1772 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1773 {
1774 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1775 struct breakpoint *b;
1776
1777 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1778
1779 sal.pc = address;
1780 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1781 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1782
1783 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1784 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1785 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1786
1787 return b;
1788 }
1789
1790 static void
1791 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1792 {
1793 struct objfile *objfile;
1794
1795 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1796 {
1797 struct breakpoint *b;
1798 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1799
1800 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1801 if (m == NULL)
1802 continue;
1803
1804 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1805 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1806 bp_overlay_event);
1807 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1808
1809 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1810 {
1811 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1812 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1813 }
1814 else
1815 {
1816 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1817 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1818 }
1819 }
1820 update_global_location_list (1);
1821 }
1822
1823 static void
1824 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1825 {
1826 struct program_space *pspace;
1827 struct objfile *objfile;
1828 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1829
1830 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1831
1832 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1833 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1834 {
1835 struct breakpoint *b;
1836 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1837
1838 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1839 continue;
1840
1841 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1842
1843 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1844 if (m == NULL)
1845 continue;
1846
1847 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1848 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1849 bp_longjmp_master);
1850 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1851 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1852 }
1853 update_global_location_list (1);
1854
1855 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1856 }
1857
1858 void
1859 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1860 {
1861 struct breakpoint *b;
1862 struct breakpoint *temp;
1863 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1864
1865 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1866 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1867 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1868 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1869 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1870 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1871 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1872 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1873 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1874 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1875 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1876
1877 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1878 {
1879 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1880 continue;
1881
1882 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1883 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1884 {
1885 delete_breakpoint (b);
1886 continue;
1887 }
1888
1889 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1890 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1891 {
1892 delete_breakpoint (b);
1893 continue;
1894 }
1895
1896 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1897 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1898 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1899 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1900 {
1901 delete_breakpoint (b);
1902 continue;
1903 }
1904
1905 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
1906 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
1907 {
1908 delete_breakpoint (b);
1909 continue;
1910 }
1911
1912 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
1913 after an exec. */
1914 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
1915 {
1916 delete_breakpoint (b);
1917 continue;
1918 }
1919
1920 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
1921 {
1922 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
1923 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
1924 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
1925 a new method, and call this method from here. */
1926 continue;
1927 }
1928
1929 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
1930 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
1931 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
1932 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
1933 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
1934 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
1935
1936 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
1937 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
1938 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
1939 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
1940 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
1941 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
1942 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
1943
1944 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
1945 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
1946 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
1947 let finish_command delete it.
1948
1949 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
1950 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
1951 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
1952 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
1953 solib breakpoints.) */
1954
1955 if (b->type == bp_finish)
1956 {
1957 continue;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
1961 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
1962 a.out. */
1963 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
1964 {
1965 delete_breakpoint (b);
1966 continue;
1967 }
1968 }
1969 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
1970 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
1971 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
1972 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
1973 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
1974 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
1975 }
1976
1977 int
1978 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
1979 {
1980 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1981 int val = 0;
1982 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1983 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
1984
1985 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
1986 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
1987
1988 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
1989 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
1990 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1991 {
1992 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1993 continue;
1994
1995 if (b->inserted)
1996 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
1997 }
1998 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1999 return val;
2000 }
2001
2002 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2003 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2004 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2005 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2006 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2007
2008 static int
2009 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2010 {
2011 int val;
2012 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2013
2014 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2015 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2016 return 0;
2017
2018 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2019 This should not ever happen. */
2020 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2021
2022 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2023 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2024 {
2025 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2026 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2027 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2028
2029 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2030 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2031 || b->section == NULL
2032 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2033 {
2034 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2035
2036 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2037 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2038 else
2039 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2040 }
2041 else
2042 {
2043 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2044 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2045 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2046 {
2047 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2048 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2049 */
2050 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2051 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2052 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2053 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2054 &b->overlay_target_info);
2055 else
2056 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2057 &b->overlay_target_info);
2058 }
2059 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2060 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2061 if (b->inserted)
2062 {
2063 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2064 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2065 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2066 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2067 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2068 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2069 &b->target_info);
2070
2071 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2072 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2073 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2074 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2075 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2076 &b->target_info);
2077 else
2078 val = 0;
2079 }
2080 else
2081 {
2082 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2083 val = 0;
2084 }
2085 }
2086
2087 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2088 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2089 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2090 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2091 val = 0;
2092
2093 if (val)
2094 return val;
2095 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2096 }
2097 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2098 {
2099 struct value *v;
2100 struct value *n;
2101
2102 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2103 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2104 b->watchpoint_type);
2105
2106 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2107 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2108 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2109 b->owner->number);
2110 }
2111 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2112 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2113 && !b->duplicate)
2114 {
2115 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2116
2117 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2118 if (val)
2119 return val;
2120 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2121 }
2122
2123 return 0;
2124 }
2125
2126 static int
2127 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2128 {
2129 int ret;
2130 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2131
2132 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2133 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2134 return 0;
2135
2136 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2137 This should not ever happen. */
2138 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2139
2140 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2141
2142 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2143
2144 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2145
2146 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2147 return ret;
2148 }
2149
2150 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2151
2152 void
2153 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2154 {
2155 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2156
2157 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2158 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2159 bpt->inserted = 0;
2160 }
2161
2162 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2163 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2164
2165 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2166 between runs.
2167
2168 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2169 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2170 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2171
2172
2173
2174 void
2175 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2176 {
2177 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2178 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2179 int ix;
2180 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2181
2182 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2183 nothing to do. */
2184 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2185 return;
2186
2187 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2188 {
2189 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2190 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2191 bpt->inserted = 0;
2192 }
2193
2194 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2195 {
2196 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2197 continue;
2198
2199 switch (b->type)
2200 {
2201 case bp_call_dummy:
2202 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2203
2204 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2205 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better
2206 get rid of it.
2207
2208 Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2209 delete_breakpoint (b);
2210 break;
2211
2212 case bp_watchpoint:
2213 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2214 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2215 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2216
2217 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2218 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2219 delete_breakpoint (b);
2220 else if (context == inf_starting)
2221 {
2222 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2223 in insert_breakpoints. */
2224 if (b->val)
2225 value_free (b->val);
2226 b->val = NULL;
2227 b->val_valid = 0;
2228 }
2229 break;
2230 default:
2231 break;
2232 }
2233 }
2234
2235 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2236 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2237 free_bp_location (bpt);
2238 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2239 }
2240
2241 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2242 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2243 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2244 match, not program space. */
2245
2246 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2247 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2248 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2249 permanent breakpoint.
2250 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2251 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2252 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2253 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2254 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2255
2256 enum breakpoint_here
2257 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2258 {
2259 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2260 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2261
2262 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2263 {
2264 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2265 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2266 continue;
2267
2268 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2269 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2270 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2271 aspace, pc))
2272 {
2273 if (overlay_debugging
2274 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2275 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2276 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2277 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2278 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2279 else
2280 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2281 }
2282 }
2283
2284 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2285 }
2286
2287 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2288
2289 int
2290 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2291 {
2292 struct bp_location *loc;
2293 int ix;
2294
2295 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2296 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2297 aspace, pc))
2298 return 1;
2299
2300 return 0;
2301 }
2302
2303 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2304 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2305 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2306 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2307
2308 int
2309 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2310 {
2311 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2312
2313 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2314 {
2315 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2316 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2317 continue;
2318
2319 if (bpt->inserted
2320 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2321 aspace, pc))
2322 {
2323 if (overlay_debugging
2324 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2325 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2326 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2327 else
2328 return 1;
2329 }
2330 }
2331 return 0;
2332 }
2333
2334 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2335 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2336
2337 int
2338 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2339 {
2340 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2341 return 1;
2342
2343 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2344 return 1;
2345
2346 return 0;
2347 }
2348
2349 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2350 inserted at PC. */
2351
2352 int
2353 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2354 {
2355 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2356 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2357
2358 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2359 {
2360 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2361 continue;
2362
2363 if (bpt->inserted
2364 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2365 aspace, pc))
2366 {
2367 if (overlay_debugging
2368 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2369 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2370 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2371 else
2372 return 1;
2373 }
2374 }
2375
2376 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2377 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2378 return 1;
2379
2380 return 0;
2381 }
2382
2383 int
2384 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2385 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2386 {
2387 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2388
2389 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2390 {
2391 struct bp_location *loc;
2392
2393 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2394 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2395 continue;
2396
2397 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2398 continue;
2399
2400 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2401 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2402 {
2403 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2404
2405 /* Check for intersection. */
2406 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2407 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2408 if (l < h)
2409 return 1;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 return 0;
2413 }
2414
2415 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2416 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2417
2418 int
2419 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2420 ptid_t ptid)
2421 {
2422 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2423 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2424 int thread = -1;
2425 int task = 0;
2426
2427 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2428 {
2429 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2430 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2431 continue;
2432
2433 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2434 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2435 continue;
2436
2437 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2438 aspace, pc))
2439 continue;
2440
2441 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2442 {
2443 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2444 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2445 it is now time to do so. */
2446 if (thread == -1)
2447 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2448 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2449 continue;
2450 }
2451
2452 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2453 {
2454 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2455 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2456 it is now time to do so. */
2457 if (task == 0)
2458 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2459 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2460 continue;
2461 }
2462
2463 if (overlay_debugging
2464 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2465 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2466 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2467
2468 return 1;
2469 }
2470
2471 return 0;
2472 }
2473 \f
2474
2475 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2476 in breakpoint.h. */
2477
2478 int
2479 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2480 {
2481 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2482 }
2483
2484 void
2485 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2486 {
2487 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2488 value_free (bs->old_val);
2489 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2490 xfree (bs);
2491 }
2492
2493 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2494 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2495
2496 void
2497 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2498 {
2499 bpstat p;
2500 bpstat q;
2501
2502 if (bsp == 0)
2503 return;
2504 p = *bsp;
2505 while (p != NULL)
2506 {
2507 q = p->next;
2508 bpstat_free (p);
2509 p = q;
2510 }
2511 *bsp = NULL;
2512 }
2513
2514 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2515 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2516
2517 bpstat
2518 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2519 {
2520 bpstat p = NULL;
2521 bpstat tmp;
2522 bpstat retval = NULL;
2523
2524 if (bs == NULL)
2525 return bs;
2526
2527 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2528 {
2529 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2530 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2531 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2532 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2533 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2534 {
2535 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2536 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2537 }
2538
2539 if (p == NULL)
2540 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2541 retval = tmp;
2542 else
2543 p->next = tmp;
2544 p = tmp;
2545 }
2546 p->next = NULL;
2547 return retval;
2548 }
2549
2550 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2551
2552 bpstat
2553 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2554 {
2555 if (bsp == NULL)
2556 return NULL;
2557
2558 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2559 {
2560 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2561 return bsp;
2562 }
2563 return NULL;
2564 }
2565
2566 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2567 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2568 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2569
2570 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2571 step_resume breakpoint.
2572
2573 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2574 struct breakpoint *
2575 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2576 {
2577 int current_thread;
2578
2579 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2580
2581 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2582
2583 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2584 {
2585 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2586 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2587 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2588 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2589 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2590 }
2591
2592 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2597 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2598 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2599 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2600 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2601 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2602 we set it.
2603 Return 1 otherwise. */
2604
2605 int
2606 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2607 {
2608 struct breakpoint *b;
2609
2610 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2611 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2612
2613 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2614 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2615 this function might return the same number more
2616 than once and this will look ugly. */
2617 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2618 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2619 if (b == NULL)
2620 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2621
2622 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2623 return 1;
2624 }
2625
2626 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2627
2628 void
2629 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2630 {
2631 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2632 {
2633 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2634 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2635 {
2636 value_free (bs->old_val);
2637 bs->old_val = NULL;
2638 }
2639 }
2640 }
2641
2642 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2643
2644 static void
2645 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2646 {
2647 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2648 {
2649 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2650
2651 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2652 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2653 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2654 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2655 if (tp->in_infcall)
2656 return;
2657 }
2658
2659 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2660 }
2661
2662 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2663 static void
2664 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2665 {
2666 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2667 }
2668
2669 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2670 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2671 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2672 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2673
2674 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2675 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2676 bpstat of the current thread. */
2677
2678 static int
2679 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2680 {
2681 bpstat bs;
2682 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2683 int again = 0;
2684
2685 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2686 in bs->commands. */
2687 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2688 return 0;
2689
2690 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2691 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2692
2693 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2694 bs = *bsp;
2695
2696 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2697 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2698 {
2699 struct command_line *cmd;
2700 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2701
2702 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2703
2704 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2705 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2706 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2707 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2708 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2709 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2710 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2711 the tree when we're done. */
2712 cmd = bs->commands;
2713 bs->commands = 0;
2714 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2715
2716 while (cmd != NULL)
2717 {
2718 execute_control_command (cmd);
2719
2720 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2721 break;
2722 else
2723 cmd = cmd->next;
2724 }
2725
2726 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2727 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2728
2729 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2730 {
2731 if (target_can_async_p ())
2732 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2733 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2734 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2735 ;
2736 else
2737 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2738 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2739 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2740 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2741 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2742 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2743 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2744 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2745 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2746 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2747 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2748 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2749 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2750 again = 1;
2751 break;
2752 }
2753 }
2754 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2755 return again;
2756 }
2757
2758 void
2759 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2760 {
2761 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2762 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2763 && target_has_execution
2764 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2765 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2766 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2767 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2768 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2769 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2770 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2771 break;
2772 }
2773
2774 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2775
2776 static void
2777 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2778 {
2779 if (val == NULL)
2780 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2781 else
2782 {
2783 struct value_print_options opts;
2784 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2785 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2786 }
2787 }
2788
2789 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2790 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2791 by having it set different print_it values.
2792
2793 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2794 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2795 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2796 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2797 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2798
2799 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2800 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2801 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2802 don't print anything else.
2803 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2804 that something to be followed by a location.
2805 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2806 that something to be followed by a location.
2807 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2808 analysis. */
2809
2810 static enum print_stop_action
2811 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2812 {
2813 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2814 struct breakpoint *b;
2815 const struct bp_location *bl;
2816 struct ui_stream *stb;
2817 int bp_temp = 0;
2818 enum print_stop_action result;
2819
2820 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2821 which has since been deleted. */
2822 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2823 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2824 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2825 b = bl->owner;
2826
2827 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2828 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2829
2830 switch (b->type)
2831 {
2832 case bp_breakpoint:
2833 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2834 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2835 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2836 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2837 bl->address,
2838 b->number, 1);
2839 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2840 if (bp_temp)
2841 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2842 else
2843 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2844 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2845 {
2846 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2847 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2848 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2849 }
2850 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2851 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2852 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2853 break;
2854
2855 case bp_shlib_event:
2856 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2857 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2858 to shlib event" message.) */
2859 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2860 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2861 break;
2862
2863 case bp_thread_event:
2864 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2865 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2866 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2867 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2868 break;
2869
2870 case bp_overlay_event:
2871 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2872 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2873 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2874 break;
2875
2876 case bp_longjmp_master:
2877 /* These should never be enabled. */
2878 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2879 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2880 break;
2881
2882 case bp_watchpoint:
2883 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2884 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2885 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2886 ui_out_field_string
2887 (uiout, "reason",
2888 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2889 mention (b);
2890 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2891 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2892 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2893 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2894 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2895 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2896 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2897 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2898 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
2899 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2900 break;
2901
2902 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2903 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2904 ui_out_field_string
2905 (uiout, "reason",
2906 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2907 mention (b);
2908 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2909 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2910 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2911 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
2912 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2913 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2914 break;
2915
2916 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2917 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2918 {
2919 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2920 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2921 ui_out_field_string
2922 (uiout, "reason",
2923 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2924 mention (b);
2925 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2926 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2927 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2928 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2929 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2930 }
2931 else
2932 {
2933 mention (b);
2934 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2935 ui_out_field_string
2936 (uiout, "reason",
2937 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2938 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2939 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2940 }
2941 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2942 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2943 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2944 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2945 break;
2946
2947 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
2948 here. */
2949
2950 case bp_finish:
2951 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2952 ui_out_field_string
2953 (uiout, "reason",
2954 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
2955 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2956 break;
2957
2958 case bp_until:
2959 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2960 ui_out_field_string
2961 (uiout, "reason",
2962 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
2963 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2964 break;
2965
2966 case bp_none:
2967 case bp_longjmp:
2968 case bp_longjmp_resume:
2969 case bp_step_resume:
2970 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2971 case bp_call_dummy:
2972 case bp_tracepoint:
2973 case bp_jit_event:
2974 default:
2975 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2976 break;
2977 }
2978
2979 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2980 return result;
2981 }
2982
2983 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
2984 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
2985 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
2986 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
2987 normal_stop(). */
2988
2989 static enum print_stop_action
2990 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
2991 {
2992 switch (bs->print_it)
2993 {
2994 case print_it_noop:
2995 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
2996 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2997 break;
2998
2999 case print_it_done:
3000 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3001 relevant messages. */
3002 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3003 break;
3004
3005 case print_it_normal:
3006 {
3007 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3008 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3009
3010 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3011 print_it_typical. */
3012 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3013 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3014 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3015 else
3016 return print_it_typical (bs);
3017 }
3018 break;
3019
3020 default:
3021 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3022 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3023 break;
3024 }
3025 }
3026
3027 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3028 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3029 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3030 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3031 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3032 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3033 routine is one of:
3034
3035 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3036 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3037 code to print the location. An example is
3038 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3039 the location.
3040 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3041 to also print the location part of the message.
3042 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3043 don't require a location appended to the end.
3044 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3045 further info to be printed.*/
3046
3047 enum print_stop_action
3048 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3049 {
3050 int val;
3051
3052 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3053 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3054 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3055 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3056 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3057 {
3058 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3059 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3060 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3061 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3062 return val;
3063 }
3064
3065 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3066 with and nothing was printed. */
3067 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3068 }
3069
3070 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3071 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3072 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3073 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3074
3075 static int
3076 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3077 {
3078 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3079 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3080 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3081 return i;
3082 }
3083
3084 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3085
3086 static bpstat
3087 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3088 {
3089 bpstat bs;
3090
3091 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3092 cbs->next = bs;
3093 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3094 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3095 bs->commands = NULL;
3096 bs->old_val = NULL;
3097 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3098 return bs;
3099 }
3100 \f
3101 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3102 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3103
3104 int
3105 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3106 {
3107 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3108 CORE_ADDR addr;
3109 struct breakpoint *b;
3110
3111 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3112 {
3113 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3114 as not triggered. */
3115 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3116 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3117 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3118 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3119 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3120
3121 return 0;
3122 }
3123
3124 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3125 {
3126 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3127 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3128 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3129 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3130 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3131 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3132 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3133
3134 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3135 }
3136
3137 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3138 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3139 triggered. */
3140
3141 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3142 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3143 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3144 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3145 {
3146 struct bp_location *loc;
3147 struct value *v;
3148
3149 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3150 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3151 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3152 sufficient. */
3153 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3154 addr, loc->address,
3155 loc->length))
3156 {
3157 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3158 break;
3159 }
3160 }
3161
3162 return 1;
3163 }
3164
3165 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3166 because of check_errors). */
3167 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3168 #define WP_DELETED 1
3169 /* The value has changed. */
3170 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3171 /* The value has not changed. */
3172 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3173
3174 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3175 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3176
3177 /* Check watchpoint condition. */
3178
3179 static int
3180 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3181 {
3182 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3183 struct breakpoint *b;
3184 struct frame_info *fr;
3185 int within_current_scope;
3186
3187 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3188
3189 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3190 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3191 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3192 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3193 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3194
3195 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3196 within_current_scope = 1;
3197 else
3198 {
3199 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3200 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3201 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3202
3203 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3204 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3205
3206 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3207 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3208 if (within_current_scope)
3209 {
3210 struct symbol *function;
3211
3212 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3213 if (function == NULL
3214 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3215 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3216 within_current_scope = 0;
3217 }
3218
3219 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3220 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3221 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3222 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3223 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3224 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3225 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3226 is likely to be wrong. */
3227 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3228 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3229
3230 if (within_current_scope)
3231 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3232 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3233 the user. */
3234 select_frame (fr);
3235 }
3236
3237 if (within_current_scope)
3238 {
3239 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3240 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3241 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3242 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3243
3244 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3245 struct value *new_val;
3246
3247 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3248 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3249 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal (b->val, new_val)))
3250 {
3251 if (new_val != NULL)
3252 {
3253 release_value (new_val);
3254 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3255 }
3256 bs->old_val = b->val;
3257 b->val = new_val;
3258 b->val_valid = 1;
3259 /* We will stop here */
3260 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3261 }
3262 else
3263 {
3264 /* Nothing changed, don't do anything. */
3265 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3266 /* We won't stop here */
3267 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3268 }
3269 }
3270 else
3271 {
3272 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3273 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3274 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3275 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3276 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3277 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3278 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3279 the first value assigned). */
3280 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3281 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3282 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3283 information here. */
3284 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3285 ui_out_field_string
3286 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3287 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3288 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3289 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3290 which its expression is valid.\n");
3291
3292 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3293 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3294 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3295
3296 return WP_DELETED;
3297 }
3298 }
3299
3300 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3301 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3302 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3303 static int
3304 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3305 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3306 {
3307 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3308
3309 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3310 tracepoints. */
3311 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint)
3312 return 0;
3313
3314 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3315 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3316 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3317 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3318 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3319 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3320 {
3321 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3322 aspace, bp_addr))
3323 return 0;
3324 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3325 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3326 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3327 return 0;
3328 }
3329
3330 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3331 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3332 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3333 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3334 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3335 (did not match the data address). */
3336
3337 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3338 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3339 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3340 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3341 return 0;
3342
3343 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3344 {
3345 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3346 return 0;
3347 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3348 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3349 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3350 return 0;
3351 }
3352
3353 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3354 {
3355 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3356 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3357 return 0;
3358 }
3359
3360 return 1;
3361 }
3362
3363 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3364 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3365 to 0. */
3366 static void
3367 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3368 {
3369 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3370 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3371
3372 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3373 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3374 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3375 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3376 {
3377 CORE_ADDR addr;
3378 struct value *v;
3379 int must_check_value = 0;
3380
3381 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3382 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3383 watched value. */
3384 must_check_value = 1;
3385 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3386 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3387 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3388 this watchpoint. */
3389 must_check_value = 1;
3390 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3391 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3392 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3393 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3394 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3395 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3396 must_check_value = 1;
3397
3398 if (must_check_value)
3399 {
3400 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3401 b->number);
3402 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3403 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3404 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3405 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3406 switch (e)
3407 {
3408 case WP_DELETED:
3409 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3410 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3411 /* Stop. */
3412 break;
3413 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3414 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3415 {
3416 /* Don't stop: read watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3417 the value has changed. This is for targets
3418 which cannot set read-only watchpoints. */
3419 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3420 bs->stop = 0;
3421 }
3422 break;
3423 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3424 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3425 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3426 {
3427 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3428 the value hasn't changed. */
3429 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3430 bs->stop = 0;
3431 }
3432 /* Stop. */
3433 break;
3434 default:
3435 /* Can't happen. */
3436 case 0:
3437 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3438 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3439 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3440 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3441 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3442 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3443 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3444 break;
3445 }
3446 }
3447 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3448 {
3449 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3450 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3451 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3452 anything for this watchpoint. */
3453 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3454 bs->stop = 0;
3455 }
3456 }
3457 }
3458
3459
3460 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3461 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3462 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3463 static void
3464 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3465 {
3466 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3467 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3468 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3469
3470 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3471 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3472 bs->stop = 0;
3473 else if (bs->stop)
3474 {
3475 int value_is_zero = 0;
3476
3477 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3478 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3479 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3480 iteration. */
3481 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3482 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3483
3484 if (bl->cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3485 {
3486 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3487 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3488 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3489 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3490 function call. */
3491 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3492
3493 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3494 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3495 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3496 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3497 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3498 call site. */
3499 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3500 value_is_zero
3501 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, (bl->cond),
3502 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3503 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3504 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3505 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3506 }
3507 if (bl->cond && value_is_zero)
3508 {
3509 bs->stop = 0;
3510 }
3511 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3512 {
3513 bs->stop = 0;
3514 }
3515 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3516 {
3517 b->ignore_count--;
3518 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3519 bs->stop = 0;
3520 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3521 stop. */
3522 ++(b->hit_count);
3523 }
3524 }
3525 }
3526
3527
3528 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3529 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3530
3531 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3532 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3533
3534 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3535
3536 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3537
3538 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3539 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3540 several reasons concurrently.)
3541
3542 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3543 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3544
3545 bpstat
3546 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3547 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3548 {
3549 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3550 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3551 struct bp_location *loc;
3552 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3553 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3554 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3555 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3556 int ix;
3557 int need_remove_insert, update_locations = 0;
3558
3559 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3560 {
3561 b = bl->owner;
3562 gdb_assert (b);
3563 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3564 continue;
3565
3566 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3567 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3568 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3569 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3570 already. */
3571 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3572 continue;
3573
3574 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3575 continue;
3576
3577 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3578
3579 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3580
3581 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3582 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3583 'stop' to 0. */
3584 bs->stop = 1;
3585 bs->print = 1;
3586
3587 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3588 if (!bs->stop)
3589 continue;
3590
3591 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3592 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3593 /* We do not stop for these. */
3594 bs->stop = 0;
3595 else
3596 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3597
3598 if (bs->stop)
3599 {
3600 if (b->enable_state != bp_disabled)
3601 ++(b->hit_count);
3602
3603 /* We will stop here */
3604 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3605 {
3606 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3607 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3608 update_locations = 1;
3609 }
3610 if (b->silent)
3611 bs->print = 0;
3612 bs->commands = b->commands;
3613 if (bs->commands
3614 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3615 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q", bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3616 {
3617 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3618 bs->print = 0;
3619 }
3620 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3621 }
3622
3623 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or if we dont print. */
3624 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3625 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3626 }
3627
3628 /* Delay this call which would break the ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration above. */
3629 if (update_locations)
3630 update_global_location_list (0);
3631
3632 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3633 {
3634 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3635 aspace, bp_addr))
3636 {
3637 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3638 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3639 bs->stop = 0;
3640 bs->print = 0;
3641 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3642 }
3643 }
3644
3645 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3646 bs = root_bs->next; /* Re-grab the head of the chain */
3647
3648 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3649 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3650 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3651 done later. */
3652 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3653 if (bs->stop)
3654 break;
3655
3656 need_remove_insert = 0;
3657 if (bs == NULL)
3658 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3659 if (!bs->stop
3660 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3661 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3662 {
3663 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3664 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3665 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3666 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3667 need_remove_insert = 1;
3668 }
3669
3670 if (need_remove_insert)
3671 update_global_location_list (1);
3672
3673 return root_bs->next;
3674 }
3675 \f
3676 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3677 struct bpstat_what
3678 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3679 {
3680 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3681 enum class
3682 {
3683 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3684 no_effect = 0,
3685
3686 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3687 wp_silent,
3688
3689 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3690 wp_noisy,
3691
3692 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3693 bp_nostop,
3694
3695 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3696 bp_silent,
3697
3698 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3699 bp_noisy,
3700
3701 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3702 long_jump,
3703
3704 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3705 long_resume,
3706
3707 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3708 step_resume,
3709
3710 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3711 shlib_event,
3712
3713 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3714 jit_event,
3715
3716 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3717 class_last
3718 };
3719
3720 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3721 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3722 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3723 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3724 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3725 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3726 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3727 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3728 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3729 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3730 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3731 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3732
3733 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3734 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3735 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3736 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3737
3738 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3739 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3740 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3741 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3742 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3743 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3744 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3745
3746 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3747 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3748 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3749 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3750 ordering is:
3751
3752 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3753 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3754 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3755 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3756 ss < jit shl sn sr
3757 sn < jit shl sr
3758 jit < shl sr
3759 shl < sr
3760 sr <
3761
3762 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3763 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3764 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3765 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3766 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3767
3768 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
3769 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
3770 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
3771
3772 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
3773 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
3774 {
3775 /* old action */
3776 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
3777 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
3778 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3779 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3780 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
3781 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3782 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3783 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
3784 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
3785 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
3786 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
3787 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
3788 };
3789
3790 #undef kc
3791 #undef ss
3792 #undef sn
3793 #undef sgl
3794 #undef slr
3795 #undef clr
3796 #undef err
3797 #undef sr
3798 #undef ts
3799 #undef shl
3800 #undef jit
3801 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
3802 struct bpstat_what retval;
3803
3804 retval.call_dummy = 0;
3805 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3806 {
3807 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
3808 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3809 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
3810 which has since been deleted. */
3811 continue;
3812 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
3813 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3814 else
3815 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
3816 {
3817 case bp_none:
3818 continue;
3819
3820 case bp_breakpoint:
3821 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3822 case bp_until:
3823 case bp_finish:
3824 if (bs->stop)
3825 {
3826 if (bs->print)
3827 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3828 else
3829 bs_class = bp_silent;
3830 }
3831 else
3832 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3833 break;
3834 case bp_watchpoint:
3835 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3836 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3837 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3838 if (bs->stop)
3839 {
3840 if (bs->print)
3841 bs_class = wp_noisy;
3842 else
3843 bs_class = wp_silent;
3844 }
3845 else
3846 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3847 This requires no further action. */
3848 bs_class = no_effect;
3849 break;
3850 case bp_longjmp:
3851 bs_class = long_jump;
3852 break;
3853 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3854 bs_class = long_resume;
3855 break;
3856 case bp_step_resume:
3857 if (bs->stop)
3858 {
3859 bs_class = step_resume;
3860 }
3861 else
3862 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
3863 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3864 break;
3865 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3866 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3867 break;
3868 case bp_shlib_event:
3869 bs_class = shlib_event;
3870 break;
3871 case bp_jit_event:
3872 bs_class = jit_event;
3873 break;
3874 case bp_thread_event:
3875 case bp_overlay_event:
3876 case bp_longjmp_master:
3877 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3878 break;
3879 case bp_catchpoint:
3880 if (bs->stop)
3881 {
3882 if (bs->print)
3883 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3884 else
3885 bs_class = bp_silent;
3886 }
3887 else
3888 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3889 This requires no further action. */
3890 bs_class = no_effect;
3891 break;
3892 case bp_call_dummy:
3893 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
3894 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
3895 bs_class = bp_silent;
3896 retval.call_dummy = 1;
3897 break;
3898 case bp_tracepoint:
3899 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
3900 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
3901 out already. */
3902 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3903 _("bpstat_what: bp_tracepoint encountered"));
3904 break;
3905 }
3906 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
3907 }
3908 retval.main_action = current_action;
3909 return retval;
3910 }
3911
3912 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
3913 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
3914 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
3915
3916 int
3917 bpstat_should_step (void)
3918 {
3919 struct breakpoint *b;
3920 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3921 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
3922 return 1;
3923 return 0;
3924 }
3925
3926 int
3927 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
3928 {
3929 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3930 if (bs->stop)
3931 return 1;
3932
3933 return 0;
3934 }
3935
3936 \f
3937
3938 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3939 struct bp_location *loc,
3940 char *wrap_indent,
3941 struct ui_stream *stb)
3942 {
3943 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3944
3945 if (loc != NULL)
3946 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
3947
3948 if (b->source_file)
3949 {
3950 struct symbol *sym
3951 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
3952 if (sym)
3953 {
3954 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
3955 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
3956 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
3957 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
3958 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
3959 }
3960 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
3961 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
3962
3963 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3964 {
3965 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
3966 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
3967
3968 if (fullname)
3969 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
3970 }
3971
3972 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
3973 }
3974 else if (!b->loc)
3975 {
3976 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
3977 }
3978 else
3979 {
3980 print_address_symbolic (loc->address, stb->stream, demangle, "");
3981 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
3982 }
3983
3984 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3985 }
3986
3987 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
3988 static void
3989 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3990 struct bp_location *loc,
3991 int loc_number,
3992 struct bp_location **last_loc,
3993 int print_address_bits,
3994 int allflag)
3995 {
3996 struct command_line *l;
3997 struct symbol *sym;
3998 struct ep_type_description
3999 {
4000 enum bptype type;
4001 char *description;
4002 };
4003 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4004 {
4005 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4006 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4007 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4008 {bp_until, "until"},
4009 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4010 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4011 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4012 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4013 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4014 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4015 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4016 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4017 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4018 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4019 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4020 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4021 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4022 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4023 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4024 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4025 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4026 };
4027
4028 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4029 char wrap_indent[80];
4030 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4031 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4032 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4033
4034 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4035 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4036 struct value_print_options opts;
4037
4038 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4039
4040 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4041 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4042 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4043 location. */
4044 if (loc == NULL
4045 && (b->loc != NULL
4046 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4047 header_of_multiple = 1;
4048 if (loc == NULL)
4049 loc = b->loc;
4050
4051 annotate_record ();
4052 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4053
4054 /* 1 */
4055 annotate_field (0);
4056 if (part_of_multiple)
4057 {
4058 char *formatted;
4059 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4060 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4061 xfree (formatted);
4062 }
4063 else
4064 {
4065 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4066 }
4067
4068 /* 2 */
4069 annotate_field (1);
4070 if (part_of_multiple)
4071 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4072 else
4073 {
4074 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4075 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4076 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4077 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4078 (int) b->type);
4079 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4080 }
4081
4082 /* 3 */
4083 annotate_field (2);
4084 if (part_of_multiple)
4085 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4086 else
4087 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4088
4089
4090 /* 4 */
4091 annotate_field (3);
4092 if (part_of_multiple)
4093 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4094 else
4095 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4096 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4097 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4098
4099
4100 /* 5 and 6 */
4101 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4102 if (opts.addressprint)
4103 {
4104 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4105 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4106 else
4107 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4108 }
4109
4110 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4111 {
4112 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4113 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4114 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4115 just one location. */
4116 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4117 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4118 }
4119 else
4120 switch (b->type)
4121 {
4122 case bp_none:
4123 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4124 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4125 break;
4126
4127 case bp_watchpoint:
4128 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4129 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4130 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4131 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4132 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4133 is relatively readable). */
4134 if (opts.addressprint)
4135 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4136 annotate_field (5);
4137 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4138 break;
4139
4140 case bp_breakpoint:
4141 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4142 case bp_until:
4143 case bp_finish:
4144 case bp_longjmp:
4145 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4146 case bp_step_resume:
4147 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4148 case bp_call_dummy:
4149 case bp_shlib_event:
4150 case bp_thread_event:
4151 case bp_overlay_event:
4152 case bp_longjmp_master:
4153 case bp_tracepoint:
4154 case bp_jit_event:
4155 if (opts.addressprint)
4156 {
4157 annotate_field (4);
4158 if (header_of_multiple)
4159 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4160 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4161 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4162 else
4163 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4164 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4165 }
4166 annotate_field (5);
4167 if (!header_of_multiple)
4168 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4169 if (b->loc)
4170 *last_loc = b->loc;
4171 break;
4172 }
4173
4174
4175 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4176 are several. */
4177 if (loc != NULL
4178 && !header_of_multiple
4179 && (allflag
4180 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4181 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4182 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4183 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4184 {
4185 struct inferior *inf;
4186 int first = 1;
4187
4188 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4189 {
4190 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4191 {
4192 if (first)
4193 {
4194 first = 0;
4195 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4196 }
4197 else
4198 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4199 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4200 }
4201 }
4202 }
4203
4204 if (!part_of_multiple)
4205 {
4206 if (b->thread != -1)
4207 {
4208 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4209 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4210 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4211 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4212 }
4213 else if (b->task != 0)
4214 {
4215 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4216 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4217 }
4218 }
4219
4220 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4221
4222 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4223 {
4224 annotate_field (6);
4225 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4226 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4227 the frame ID. */
4228 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4229 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4230 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4231 }
4232
4233 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4234 {
4235 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4236 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4237 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4238 annotate_field (7);
4239 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint)
4240 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4241 else
4242 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4243 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4244 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4245 }
4246
4247 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4248 {
4249 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4250 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4251 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4252 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4253 }
4254
4255 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4256 {
4257 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4258 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4259 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4260 else
4261 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4262 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4263 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4264 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4265 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4266 else
4267 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4268 }
4269
4270 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4271 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4272 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4273 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4274 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4275
4276 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4277 {
4278 annotate_field (8);
4279 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4280 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4281 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4282 }
4283
4284 l = b->commands;
4285 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4286 {
4287 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4288
4289 annotate_field (9);
4290 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4291 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4292 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4293 }
4294
4295 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4296 {
4297 annotate_field (10);
4298 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4299 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4300 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4301 }
4302
4303 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4304 {
4305 annotate_field (11);
4306 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4307 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4308 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4309 }
4310
4311 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4312 {
4313 struct action_line *action;
4314 annotate_field (12);
4315 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4316 {
4317 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4318 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4319 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4320 }
4321 }
4322
4323 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4324 {
4325 if (b->addr_string)
4326 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4327 else if (b->exp_string)
4328 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4329 }
4330
4331 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4332 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4333 }
4334
4335 static void
4336 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4337 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4338 int allflag)
4339 {
4340 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4341 print_address_bits, allflag);
4342
4343 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4344 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4345 locations, if any. */
4346 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4347 {
4348 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4349 disabled, we print it as if it had
4350 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4351 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4352 situation.
4353 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4354 several locations internally, that's no a property
4355 exposed to user. */
4356 if (b->loc
4357 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4358 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4359 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4360 {
4361 struct bp_location *loc;
4362 int n = 1;
4363 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4364 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4365 print_address_bits, allflag);
4366 }
4367 }
4368 }
4369
4370 static int
4371 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4372 {
4373 int print_address_bits = 0;
4374 struct bp_location *loc;
4375
4376 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4377 {
4378 int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4379 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4380 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4381 }
4382
4383 return print_address_bits;
4384 }
4385
4386 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4387 {
4388 int bnum;
4389 };
4390
4391 static int
4392 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4393 {
4394 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4395 struct breakpoint *b;
4396 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4397 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4398 {
4399 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4400 {
4401 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4402 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4403 return GDB_RC_OK;
4404 }
4405 }
4406 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4407 }
4408
4409 enum gdb_rc
4410 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4411 {
4412 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4413 args.bnum = bnum;
4414 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4415 an error. */
4416 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4417 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4418 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4419 else
4420 return GDB_RC_OK;
4421 }
4422
4423 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4424 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4425
4426 static int
4427 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4428 {
4429 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4430 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4431 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4432 || b->type == bp_tracepoint
4433 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4434 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4435 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4436 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4437 }
4438
4439 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4440 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4441 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4442
4443 static void
4444 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4445 {
4446 struct breakpoint *b;
4447 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4448 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4449 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4450 struct value_print_options opts;
4451 int print_address_bits = 0;
4452
4453 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4454
4455 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4456 size required for address fields. */
4457 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4458 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4459 if (bnum == -1
4460 || bnum == b->number)
4461 {
4462 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4463 {
4464 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4465 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4466 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4467
4468 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4469 }
4470 }
4471
4472 if (opts.addressprint)
4473 bkpttbl_chain
4474 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4475 "BreakpointTable");
4476 else
4477 bkpttbl_chain
4478 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4479 "BreakpointTable");
4480
4481 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4482 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4483 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4484 annotate_field (0);
4485 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4486 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4487 annotate_field (1);
4488 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4489 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4490 annotate_field (2);
4491 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4492 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4493 annotate_field (3);
4494 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4495 if (opts.addressprint)
4496 {
4497 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4498 annotate_field (4);
4499 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4500 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4501 else
4502 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4503 }
4504 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4505 annotate_field (5);
4506 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4507 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4508 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4509 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4510
4511 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4512 if (bnum == -1
4513 || bnum == b->number)
4514 {
4515 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4516 allflag is set. */
4517 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4518 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4519 }
4520
4521 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4522
4523 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4524 {
4525 if (bnum == -1)
4526 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4527 else
4528 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4529 bnum);
4530 }
4531 else
4532 {
4533 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4534 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4535 }
4536
4537 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4538 there have been breakpoints? */
4539 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4540 }
4541
4542 static void
4543 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4544 {
4545 int bnum = -1;
4546
4547 if (bnum_exp)
4548 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4549
4550 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4551 }
4552
4553 static void
4554 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4555 {
4556 int bnum = -1;
4557
4558 if (bnum_exp)
4559 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4560
4561 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4562 }
4563
4564 static int
4565 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4566 struct program_space *pspace,
4567 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4568 {
4569 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4570 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4571 {
4572 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4573 && bl->address == pc
4574 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4575 return 1;
4576 }
4577 return 0;
4578 }
4579
4580 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4581 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4582 address spaces. */
4583
4584 static void
4585 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4586 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4587 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4588 {
4589 int others = 0;
4590 struct breakpoint *b;
4591
4592 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4593 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4594 if (others > 0)
4595 {
4596 if (others == 1)
4597 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4598 else /* if (others == ???) */
4599 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4600 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4601 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4602 {
4603 others--;
4604 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4605 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4606 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4607 else if (b->thread != -1)
4608 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4609 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4610 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4611 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4612 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4613 ? " (disabled)"
4614 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4615 ? " (permanent)"
4616 : ""),
4617 (others > 1) ? ","
4618 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4619 }
4620 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4621 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4622 printf_filtered (".\n");
4623 }
4624 }
4625 \f
4626 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4627 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4628
4629 void
4630 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4631 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4632 int line)
4633 {
4634 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4635 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4636 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4637 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4638 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4639 }
4640
4641 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4642 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4643 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4644 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4645
4646 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4647 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4648 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4649
4650 bp_watchpoint
4651 bp_catchpoint
4652
4653 */
4654
4655 static int
4656 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4657 {
4658 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4659
4660 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4661 }
4662
4663 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4664 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4665
4666 static int
4667 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4668 {
4669 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4670 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4671 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4672 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4673 }
4674
4675 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4676 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4677 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4678 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4679
4680 static int
4681 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4682 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4683 {
4684 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4685 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4686 && addr1 == addr2);
4687 }
4688
4689 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4690 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4691 represent the same location. */
4692
4693 static int
4694 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4695 {
4696 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4697 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4698
4699 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4700 return 0;
4701 else if (hw_point1)
4702 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4703 else
4704 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4705 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4706 }
4707
4708 static void
4709 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4710 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4711 {
4712 char astr1[40];
4713 char astr2[40];
4714
4715 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4716 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4717 if (have_bnum)
4718 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4719 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4720 else
4721 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4722 }
4723
4724 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4725 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4726 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4727 this function is simply the identity function. */
4728
4729 static CORE_ADDR
4730 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4731 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4732 {
4733 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4734 {
4735 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4736 return bpaddr;
4737 }
4738 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4739 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4740 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4741 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4742 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4743 {
4744 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
4745 have their addresses modified. */
4746 return bpaddr;
4747 }
4748 else
4749 {
4750 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
4751
4752 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
4753 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
4754 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
4755
4756 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
4757 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
4758 is required. */
4759 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
4760 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
4761
4762 return adjusted_bpaddr;
4763 }
4764 }
4765
4766 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
4767
4768 static struct bp_location *
4769 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4770 {
4771 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
4772
4773 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
4774 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
4775
4776 loc->owner = bpt;
4777 loc->cond = NULL;
4778 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
4779 loc->enabled = 1;
4780
4781 switch (bpt->type)
4782 {
4783 case bp_breakpoint:
4784 case bp_tracepoint:
4785 case bp_until:
4786 case bp_finish:
4787 case bp_longjmp:
4788 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4789 case bp_step_resume:
4790 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4791 case bp_call_dummy:
4792 case bp_shlib_event:
4793 case bp_thread_event:
4794 case bp_overlay_event:
4795 case bp_jit_event:
4796 case bp_longjmp_master:
4797 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
4798 break;
4799 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4800 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
4801 break;
4802 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4803 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4804 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4805 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
4806 break;
4807 case bp_watchpoint:
4808 case bp_catchpoint:
4809 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
4810 break;
4811 default:
4812 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
4813 }
4814
4815 return loc;
4816 }
4817
4818 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
4819 {
4820 if (loc->cond)
4821 xfree (loc->cond);
4822
4823 if (loc->function_name)
4824 xfree (loc->function_name);
4825
4826 xfree (loc);
4827 }
4828
4829 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
4830 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
4831 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
4832
4833 static struct breakpoint *
4834 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4835 enum bptype bptype)
4836 {
4837 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
4838
4839 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
4840 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
4841
4842 b->type = bptype;
4843 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
4844 b->language = current_language->la_language;
4845 b->input_radix = input_radix;
4846 b->thread = -1;
4847 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
4848 b->next = 0;
4849 b->silent = 0;
4850 b->ignore_count = 0;
4851 b->commands = NULL;
4852 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
4853 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
4854 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
4855 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
4856 b->ops = NULL;
4857 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
4858
4859 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
4860 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
4861 of increasing numbers. */
4862
4863 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
4864 if (b1 == 0)
4865 breakpoint_chain = b;
4866 else
4867 {
4868 while (b1->next)
4869 b1 = b1->next;
4870 b1->next = b;
4871 }
4872 return b;
4873 }
4874
4875 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
4876 static void
4877 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
4878 {
4879 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
4880 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4881 || loc->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
4882 {
4883 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
4884 NULL, NULL);
4885 if (loc->function_name)
4886 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
4887 }
4888 }
4889
4890 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
4891 static struct gdbarch *
4892 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
4893 {
4894 if (sal.section)
4895 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
4896 if (sal.symtab)
4897 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
4898
4899 return NULL;
4900 }
4901
4902 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
4903 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
4904 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
4905 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
4906 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
4907 is also returned as the value of this function.
4908
4909 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
4910 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
4911 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
4912 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
4913 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
4914 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
4915 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
4916
4917 struct breakpoint *
4918 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4919 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
4920 {
4921 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
4922 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
4923 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
4924
4925 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
4926 if (!loc_gdbarch)
4927 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
4928
4929 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
4930 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
4931
4932 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
4933 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
4934 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
4935 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
4936 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
4937 location that's only been partially initialized. */
4938 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
4939
4940 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
4941 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
4942 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
4943 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
4944 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
4945
4946 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
4947 breakpoint resetting. */
4948 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
4949
4950 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
4951 b->source_file = NULL;
4952 else
4953 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
4954 b->loc->section = sal.section;
4955 b->line_number = sal.line;
4956
4957 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
4958
4959 breakpoints_changed ();
4960
4961 return b;
4962 }
4963
4964
4965 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
4966 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
4967 void
4968 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
4969 {
4970 struct bp_location *bl;
4971 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
4972
4973 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
4974 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
4975 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
4976 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
4977 but it's easy to implmement. */
4978 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
4979 bl->inserted = 1;
4980 }
4981
4982 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
4983 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
4984 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
4985
4986 void
4987 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
4988 {
4989 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
4990
4991 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
4992 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
4993 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
4994 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
4995 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
4996 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
4997 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
4998 {
4999 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5000 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5001 clone->thread = thread;
5002 }
5003 }
5004
5005 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5006 void
5007 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5008 {
5009 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5010
5011 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5012 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5013 {
5014 if (b->thread == thread)
5015 delete_breakpoint (b);
5016 }
5017 }
5018
5019 void
5020 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5021 {
5022 struct breakpoint *b;
5023
5024 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5025 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5026 {
5027 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5028 update_global_location_list (1);
5029 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5030 }
5031 }
5032
5033 void
5034 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5035 {
5036 struct breakpoint *b;
5037
5038 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5039 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5040 {
5041 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5042 update_global_location_list (0);
5043 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5044 }
5045 }
5046
5047 struct breakpoint *
5048 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5049 {
5050 struct breakpoint *b;
5051
5052 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5053
5054 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5055 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5056 b->addr_string
5057 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5058
5059 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5060
5061 return b;
5062 }
5063
5064 void
5065 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5066 {
5067 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5068
5069 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5070 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5071 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5072 delete_breakpoint (b);
5073 }
5074
5075 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5076 {
5077 char **arg_p;
5078 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5079 char ***addr_string_p;
5080 int *not_found_ptr;
5081 };
5082
5083 struct lang_and_radix
5084 {
5085 enum language lang;
5086 int radix;
5087 };
5088
5089 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5090
5091 struct breakpoint *
5092 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5093 {
5094 struct breakpoint *b;
5095
5096 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5097 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5098 return b;
5099 }
5100
5101 void
5102 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5103 {
5104 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5105
5106 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5107 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5108 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5109 delete_breakpoint (b);
5110 }
5111
5112 struct breakpoint *
5113 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5114 {
5115 struct breakpoint *b;
5116
5117 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5118 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5119 return b;
5120 }
5121
5122 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5123 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5124
5125 void
5126 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5127 {
5128 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5129
5130 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5131 {
5132 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5133 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5134 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5135 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5136 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5137 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5138 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5139 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5140 || (b->type == bp_tracepoint))
5141 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5142 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5143 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5144 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5145 #else
5146 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5147 #endif
5148 )
5149 {
5150 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5151 }
5152 }
5153 }
5154
5155 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5156 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5157
5158 static void
5159 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5160 {
5161 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5162 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5163
5164 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5165 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5166 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5167 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5168 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5169 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5170 return;
5171
5172 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5173 {
5174 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5175 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5176 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5177 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5178 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5179 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5180 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5181 {
5182 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5183 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5184 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5185 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5186 loc->inserted = 0;
5187 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5188 {
5189 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5190 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5191 solib->so_name);
5192 }
5193 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5194 }
5195 }
5196 }
5197
5198 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5199
5200 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5201
5202 static void
5203 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5204 {
5205 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5206 }
5207
5208 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5209
5210 static int
5211 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5212 {
5213 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5214 }
5215
5216 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5217 catchpoints. */
5218
5219 static int
5220 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5221 {
5222 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5223 }
5224
5225 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5226
5227 static enum print_stop_action
5228 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5229 {
5230 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5231 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5232 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5233 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5234 }
5235
5236 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5237
5238 static void
5239 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5240 {
5241 struct value_print_options opts;
5242
5243 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5244
5245 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5246 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5247 is relatively readable). */
5248 if (opts.addressprint)
5249 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5250 annotate_field (5);
5251 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5252 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5253 {
5254 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5255 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5256 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5257 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5258 }
5259 }
5260
5261 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5262 catchpoints. */
5263
5264 static void
5265 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5266 {
5267 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5268 }
5269
5270 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5271
5272 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5273 {
5274 insert_catch_fork,
5275 remove_catch_fork,
5276 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5277 print_it_catch_fork,
5278 print_one_catch_fork,
5279 print_mention_catch_fork
5280 };
5281
5282 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5283
5284 static void
5285 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5286 {
5287 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5288 }
5289
5290 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5291
5292 static int
5293 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5294 {
5295 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5296 }
5297
5298 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5299 catchpoints. */
5300
5301 static int
5302 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5303 {
5304 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5305 }
5306
5307 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5308
5309 static enum print_stop_action
5310 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5311 {
5312 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5313 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5314 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5315 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5316 }
5317
5318 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5319
5320 static void
5321 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5322 {
5323 struct value_print_options opts;
5324
5325 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5326 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5327 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5328 is relatively readable). */
5329 if (opts.addressprint)
5330 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5331 annotate_field (5);
5332 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5333 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5334 {
5335 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5336 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5337 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5338 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5339 }
5340 }
5341
5342 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5343 catchpoints. */
5344
5345 static void
5346 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5347 {
5348 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5349 }
5350
5351 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5352
5353 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5354 {
5355 insert_catch_vfork,
5356 remove_catch_vfork,
5357 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5358 print_it_catch_vfork,
5359 print_one_catch_vfork,
5360 print_mention_catch_vfork
5361 };
5362
5363 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5364 catchpoints. */
5365
5366 static void
5367 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5368 {
5369 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5370
5371 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5372 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5373 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5374 else
5375 {
5376 int i, iter;
5377 for (i = 0;
5378 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5379 i++)
5380 {
5381 int elem;
5382 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5383 {
5384 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5385 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5386 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5387 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5388 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5389 vec_addr_offset;
5390 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5391 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5392 }
5393 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5394 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5395 }
5396 }
5397
5398 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5399 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5400 inf->any_syscall_count,
5401 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5402 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5403 }
5404
5405 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5406 catchpoints. */
5407
5408 static int
5409 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5410 {
5411 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5412
5413 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5414 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5415 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5416 else
5417 {
5418 int i, iter;
5419 for (i = 0;
5420 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5421 i++)
5422 {
5423 int elem;
5424 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5425 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5426 continue;
5427 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5428 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5429 }
5430 }
5431
5432 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5433 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5434 inf->any_syscall_count,
5435 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5436 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5437 }
5438
5439 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5440 catchpoints. */
5441
5442 static int
5443 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5444 {
5445 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5446 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5447 syscall we are catching. */
5448 int syscall_number = 0;
5449
5450 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5451 return 0;
5452
5453 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5454 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5455 {
5456 int i, iter;
5457 for (i = 0;
5458 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5459 i++)
5460 if (syscall_number == iter)
5461 break;
5462 /* Not the same. */
5463 if (!iter)
5464 return 0;
5465 }
5466
5467 return 1;
5468 }
5469
5470 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5471 catchpoints. */
5472
5473 static enum print_stop_action
5474 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5475 {
5476 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5477 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5478 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5479 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5480 ptid_t ptid;
5481 struct target_waitstatus last;
5482 struct syscall s;
5483 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5484 char *syscall_id;
5485
5486 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5487
5488 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5489
5490 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5491
5492 if (s.name == NULL)
5493 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5494 else
5495 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5496
5497 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5498
5499 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5500 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5501 b->number, syscall_id);
5502 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5503 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5504 b->number, syscall_id);
5505
5506 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5507
5508 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5509 }
5510
5511 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5512 catchpoints. */
5513
5514 static void
5515 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5516 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5517 {
5518 struct value_print_options opts;
5519
5520 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5521 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5522 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5523 is relatively readable). */
5524 if (opts.addressprint)
5525 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5526 annotate_field (5);
5527
5528 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5529 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5530 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5531 else
5532 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5533
5534 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5535 {
5536 int i, iter;
5537 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5538 for (i = 0;
5539 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5540 i++)
5541 {
5542 char *x = text;
5543 struct syscall s;
5544 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5545
5546 if (s.name != NULL)
5547 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5548 else
5549 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5550
5551 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5552 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5553 on every call. */
5554 xfree (x);
5555 }
5556 /* Remove the last comma. */
5557 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5558 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5559 }
5560 else
5561 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5562 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5563 }
5564
5565 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5566 catchpoints. */
5567
5568 static void
5569 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5570 {
5571 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5572 {
5573 int i, iter;
5574
5575 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5576 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5577 else
5578 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5579
5580 for (i = 0;
5581 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5582 i++)
5583 {
5584 struct syscall s;
5585 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5586
5587 if (s.name)
5588 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5589 else
5590 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5591 }
5592 printf_filtered (")");
5593 }
5594 else
5595 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5596 b->number);
5597 }
5598
5599 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5600
5601 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5602 {
5603 insert_catch_syscall,
5604 remove_catch_syscall,
5605 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5606 print_it_catch_syscall,
5607 print_one_catch_syscall,
5608 print_mention_catch_syscall
5609 };
5610
5611 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5612
5613 static int
5614 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5615 {
5616 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5617 }
5618
5619 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5620 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5621 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5622 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5623
5624 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5625 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5626 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5627 to the catchpoint. */
5628
5629 static struct breakpoint *
5630 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5631 char *cond_string,
5632 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5633 {
5634 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5635 struct breakpoint *b;
5636
5637 init_sal (&sal);
5638 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5639
5640 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5641 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5642 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5643
5644 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5645 b->thread = -1;
5646 b->addr_string = NULL;
5647 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5648 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5649 b->ops = ops;
5650
5651 return b;
5652 }
5653
5654 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5655
5656 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5657 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5658 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5659 to the catchpoint. */
5660
5661 static struct breakpoint *
5662 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5663 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5664 {
5665 struct breakpoint *b =
5666 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5667
5668 mention (b);
5669 update_global_location_list (1);
5670
5671 return b;
5672 }
5673
5674 static void
5675 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5676 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5677 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5678 {
5679 struct breakpoint *b
5680 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5681
5682 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5683 area. */
5684 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5685 }
5686
5687 /* Exec catchpoints. */
5688
5689 static void
5690 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5691 {
5692 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5693 }
5694
5695 static int
5696 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5697 {
5698 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5699 }
5700
5701 static int
5702 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5703 {
5704 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5705 }
5706
5707 static enum print_stop_action
5708 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5709 {
5710 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5711 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5712 b->exec_pathname);
5713 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5714 }
5715
5716 static void
5717 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5718 {
5719 struct value_print_options opts;
5720
5721 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5722
5723 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5724 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5725 is relatively readable). */
5726 if (opts.addressprint)
5727 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5728 annotate_field (5);
5729 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5730 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5731 {
5732 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5733 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5734 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5735 }
5736 }
5737
5738 static void
5739 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5740 {
5741 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5742 }
5743
5744 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
5745 {
5746 insert_catch_exec,
5747 remove_catch_exec,
5748 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
5749 print_it_catch_exec,
5750 print_one_catch_exec,
5751 print_mention_catch_exec
5752 };
5753
5754 static void
5755 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
5756 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5757 {
5758 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
5759 struct breakpoint *b =
5760 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
5761
5762 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
5763
5764 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
5765 location list. */
5766 mention (b);
5767 update_global_location_list (1);
5768 }
5769
5770 static int
5771 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
5772 {
5773 struct breakpoint *b;
5774 int i = 0;
5775
5776 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5777 {
5778 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5779 i++;
5780 }
5781
5782 return i;
5783 }
5784
5785 static int
5786 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
5787 {
5788 struct breakpoint *b;
5789 int i = 0;
5790
5791 *other_type_used = 0;
5792 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5793 {
5794 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
5795 {
5796 if (b->type == type)
5797 i++;
5798 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5799 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
5800 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5801 *other_type_used = 1;
5802 }
5803 }
5804 return i;
5805 }
5806
5807 void
5808 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
5809 {
5810 struct breakpoint *b;
5811
5812 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5813 {
5814 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5815 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5816 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5817 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5818 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5819 {
5820 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
5821 update_global_location_list (0);
5822 }
5823 }
5824 }
5825
5826 void
5827 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
5828 {
5829 struct breakpoint *b;
5830
5831 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5832 {
5833 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5834 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5835 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5836 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5837 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
5838 {
5839 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5840 update_global_location_list (1);
5841 }
5842 }
5843 }
5844
5845 void
5846 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
5847 {
5848 struct breakpoint *b;
5849 int found = 0;
5850
5851 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5852 {
5853 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5854 continue;
5855
5856 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5857 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5858 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5859 {
5860 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
5861 found = 1;
5862 }
5863 }
5864
5865 if (found)
5866 update_global_location_list (0);
5867
5868 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
5869 }
5870
5871 void
5872 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
5873 {
5874 struct breakpoint *b;
5875 int found = 0;
5876
5877 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
5878
5879 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5880 {
5881 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5882 continue;
5883
5884 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5885 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5886 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5887 {
5888 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5889 found = 1;
5890 }
5891 }
5892
5893 if (found)
5894 breakpoint_re_set ();
5895 }
5896
5897
5898 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
5899 at address specified by SAL.
5900 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
5901
5902 struct breakpoint *
5903 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
5904 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
5905 {
5906 struct breakpoint *b;
5907
5908 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
5909 one. */
5910 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
5911
5912 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
5913 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5914 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5915 b->frame_id = frame_id;
5916
5917 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
5918 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
5919 single thread of control. */
5920 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
5921 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
5922
5923 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5924
5925 return b;
5926 }
5927
5928 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
5929 ORIG is NULL. */
5930
5931 struct breakpoint *
5932 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
5933 {
5934 struct breakpoint *copy;
5935
5936 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
5937 if (orig == NULL)
5938 return NULL;
5939
5940 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
5941 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
5942 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
5943
5944 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
5945 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
5946 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
5947 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
5948 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
5949
5950 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
5951 copy->source_file = NULL;
5952 else
5953 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
5954
5955 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
5956 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
5957 copy->thread = orig->thread;
5958 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
5959
5960 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5961 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5962 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
5963
5964 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
5965 return copy;
5966 }
5967
5968 struct breakpoint *
5969 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
5970 enum bptype type)
5971 {
5972 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5973
5974 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
5975 sal.pc = pc;
5976 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
5977 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
5978
5979 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
5980 }
5981 \f
5982
5983 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
5984
5985 static void
5986 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
5987 {
5988 int say_where = 0;
5989 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
5990 struct value_print_options opts;
5991
5992 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5993
5994 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
5995 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
5996 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
5997 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
5998 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
5999
6000 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6001 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6002 else
6003 switch (b->type)
6004 {
6005 case bp_none:
6006 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6007 break;
6008 case bp_watchpoint:
6009 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6010 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6011 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6012 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6013 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6014 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6015 break;
6016 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6017 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6018 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6019 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6020 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6021 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6022 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6023 break;
6024 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6025 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6026 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6027 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6028 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6029 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6030 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6031 break;
6032 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6033 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6034 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6035 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6036 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6037 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6038 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6039 break;
6040 case bp_breakpoint:
6041 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6042 {
6043 say_where = 0;
6044 break;
6045 }
6046 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6047 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6048 else
6049 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6050 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6051 say_where = 1;
6052 break;
6053 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6054 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6055 {
6056 say_where = 0;
6057 break;
6058 }
6059 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6060 say_where = 1;
6061 break;
6062 case bp_tracepoint:
6063 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6064 {
6065 say_where = 0;
6066 break;
6067 }
6068 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6069 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6070 say_where = 1;
6071 break;
6072
6073 case bp_until:
6074 case bp_finish:
6075 case bp_longjmp:
6076 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6077 case bp_step_resume:
6078 case bp_call_dummy:
6079 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6080 case bp_shlib_event:
6081 case bp_thread_event:
6082 case bp_overlay_event:
6083 case bp_jit_event:
6084 case bp_longjmp_master:
6085 break;
6086 }
6087
6088 if (say_where)
6089 {
6090 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6091 single string. */
6092 if (b->loc == NULL)
6093 {
6094 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6095 }
6096 else
6097 {
6098 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6099 {
6100 printf_filtered (" at ");
6101 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6102 gdb_stdout);
6103 }
6104 if (b->source_file)
6105 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6106 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6107
6108 if (b->loc->next)
6109 {
6110 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6111 int n = 0;
6112 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6113 ++n;
6114 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6115 }
6116
6117 }
6118 }
6119 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6120 return;
6121 printf_filtered ("\n");
6122 }
6123 \f
6124
6125 static struct bp_location *
6126 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6127 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6128 {
6129 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6130
6131 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6132 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6133 ;
6134 *tmp = loc;
6135 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6136 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6137 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6138 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6139 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6140 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6141 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6142 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6143 loc->section = sal->section;
6144
6145 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6146 return loc;
6147 }
6148 \f
6149
6150 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6151 return 0 otherwise. */
6152
6153 static int
6154 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6155 {
6156 int len;
6157 CORE_ADDR addr;
6158 const gdb_byte *brk;
6159 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6160 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6161 int retval = 0;
6162
6163 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6164
6165 addr = loc->address;
6166 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6167
6168 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6169 if (brk == NULL)
6170 return 0;
6171
6172 target_mem = alloca (len);
6173
6174 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6175 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6176 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6177 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6178
6179 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6180 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6181
6182 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6183 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6184 retval = 1;
6185
6186 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6187
6188 return retval;
6189 }
6190
6191
6192
6193 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6194 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6195 as condition expression. */
6196
6197 static void
6198 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6199 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6200 char *cond_string,
6201 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6202 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6203 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6204 {
6205 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6206 int i;
6207
6208 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6209 {
6210 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6211 int target_resources_ok =
6212 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6213 i + 1, 0);
6214 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6215 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6216 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6217 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6218 }
6219
6220 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6221
6222 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6223 {
6224 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6225 struct bp_location *loc;
6226
6227 if (from_tty)
6228 {
6229 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6230 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6231 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6232
6233 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6234 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6235 }
6236
6237 if (i == 0)
6238 {
6239 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6240 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6241 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6242 b->thread = thread;
6243 b->task = task;
6244
6245 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6246 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6247 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6248 b->disposition = disposition;
6249
6250 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6251
6252 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6253 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6254 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6255 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6256
6257 loc = b->loc;
6258 }
6259 else
6260 {
6261 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6262 }
6263
6264 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6265 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6266
6267 if (b->cond_string)
6268 {
6269 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6270 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6271 if (*arg)
6272 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6273 }
6274 }
6275
6276 if (addr_string)
6277 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6278 else
6279 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6280 me. */
6281 b->addr_string
6282 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6283
6284 b->ops = ops;
6285 mention (b);
6286 }
6287
6288 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6289 elements to fill the void space. */
6290 static void
6291 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6292 {
6293 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6294 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6295
6296 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6297 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6298
6299 --(sal->nelts);
6300 }
6301
6302 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6303 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6304 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6305 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6306 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6307 single expanded sal, return the original.
6308
6309 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6310 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6311 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6312 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6313 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6314
6315 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6316 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6317 {
6318 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6319 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6320 char *original_function = NULL;
6321 int found;
6322 int i;
6323 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6324
6325 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6326 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6327 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6328 {
6329 expanded.nelts = 1;
6330 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6331 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6332 return expanded;
6333 }
6334
6335 sal.pc = 0;
6336
6337 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6338
6339 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6340
6341 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6342
6343 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6344 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6345
6346 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6347 {
6348 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6349 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6350 xfree (expanded.sals);
6351 expanded.nelts = 1;
6352 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6353 sal.pc = original_pc;
6354 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6355 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6356 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6357 return expanded;
6358 }
6359
6360 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6361 {
6362 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6363 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6364 {
6365 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6366 char *this_function;
6367
6368 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6369 read memory. */
6370 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6371
6372 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6373 &func_addr, &func_end))
6374 {
6375 if (this_function
6376 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6377 {
6378 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6379 --i;
6380 }
6381 else if (func_addr == pc)
6382 {
6383 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6384 skip prologue. */
6385 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6386 if (sym)
6387 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6388 else
6389 {
6390 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6391 we should really always find the section here. */
6392 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6393 if (section)
6394 {
6395 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6396 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6397 expanded.sals[i].pc
6398 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6399 }
6400 }
6401 }
6402 }
6403 }
6404 }
6405 else
6406 {
6407 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6408 {
6409 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6410 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6411 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6412 }
6413 }
6414
6415 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6416
6417 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6418 {
6419 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6420 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6421 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6422 xfree (expanded.sals);
6423 expanded.nelts = 1;
6424 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6425 sal.pc = original_pc;
6426 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6427 return expanded;
6428 }
6429
6430 if (original_pc)
6431 {
6432 found = 0;
6433 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6434 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6435 {
6436 found = 1;
6437 break;
6438 }
6439 gdb_assert (found);
6440 }
6441
6442 return expanded;
6443 }
6444
6445 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6446 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6447 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6448 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6449 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6450 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6451 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6452 we take just a single condition string.
6453
6454 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6455 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6456 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6457 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6458 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6459
6460 static void
6461 create_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6462 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6463 char *cond_string,
6464 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6465 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6466 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6467 int enabled)
6468 {
6469 int i;
6470 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6471 {
6472 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6473 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6474
6475 create_breakpoint (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6476 cond_string, type, disposition,
6477 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6478 }
6479 }
6480
6481 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6482 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6483 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6484 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6485
6486 static void
6487 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6488 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6489 char ***addr_string,
6490 int *not_found_ptr)
6491 {
6492 char *addr_start = *address;
6493 *addr_string = NULL;
6494 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6495 breakpoint. */
6496 if ((*address) == NULL
6497 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6498 {
6499 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6500 {
6501 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6502 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6503 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6504 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6505 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6506 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6507 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6508 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6509 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6510
6511 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6512 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6513 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6514 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6515 */
6516 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6517
6518 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6519 sals->nelts = 1;
6520 }
6521 else
6522 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6523 }
6524 else
6525 {
6526 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6527 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6528 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6529 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6530 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6531 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6532
6533 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6534
6535 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6536 && (!cursal.symtab
6537 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6538 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6539 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6540 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6541 not_found_ptr);
6542 else
6543 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6544 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6545 }
6546 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6547 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6548 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6549 if (addr_start != (*address))
6550 {
6551 int i;
6552 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6553 {
6554 /* Add the string if not present. */
6555 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6556 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6557 }
6558 }
6559 }
6560
6561
6562 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6563 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6564
6565 static void
6566 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6567 char *address)
6568 {
6569 int i;
6570 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6571 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6572 }
6573
6574 static void
6575 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6576 {
6577 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6578
6579 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6580 args->not_found_ptr);
6581 }
6582
6583 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6584 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6585 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6586 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6587 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6588 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6589 static void
6590 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6591 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6592 {
6593 *cond_string = NULL;
6594 *thread = -1;
6595 while (tok && *tok)
6596 {
6597 char *end_tok;
6598 int toklen;
6599 char *cond_start = NULL;
6600 char *cond_end = NULL;
6601 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6602 tok++;
6603
6604 end_tok = tok;
6605
6606 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6607 end_tok++;
6608
6609 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6610
6611 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6612 {
6613 struct expression *expr;
6614
6615 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6616 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6617 xfree (expr);
6618 cond_end = tok;
6619 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6620 cond_end - cond_start);
6621 }
6622 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6623 {
6624 char *tmptok;
6625
6626 tok = end_tok + 1;
6627 tmptok = tok;
6628 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6629 if (tok == tmptok)
6630 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6631 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6632 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6633 }
6634 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6635 {
6636 char *tmptok;
6637
6638 tok = end_tok + 1;
6639 tmptok = tok;
6640 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6641 if (tok == tmptok)
6642 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6643 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6644 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6645 }
6646 else
6647 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6648 }
6649 }
6650
6651 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between
6652 CLI and MI functions for setting a breakpoint.
6653 This function has two major modes of operations,
6654 selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD parameter.
6655 If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6656 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise,
6657 ARG is just the location of breakpoint, with condition
6658 and thread specified by the COND_STRING and THREAD
6659 parameters. */
6660
6661 static void
6662 break_command_really (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6663 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6664 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6665 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6666 int ignore_count,
6667 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6668 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6669 int from_tty,
6670 int enabled)
6671 {
6672 struct gdb_exception e;
6673 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6674 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6675 char *copy_arg;
6676 char *err_msg;
6677 char *addr_start = arg;
6678 char **addr_string;
6679 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6680 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6681 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6682 int i;
6683 int pending = 0;
6684 int not_found = 0;
6685 enum bptype type_wanted;
6686 int task = 0;
6687
6688 sals.sals = NULL;
6689 sals.nelts = 0;
6690 addr_string = NULL;
6691
6692 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6693 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6694 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6695 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6696
6697 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6698 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6699
6700 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
6701 switch (e.reason)
6702 {
6703 case RETURN_QUIT:
6704 throw_exception (e);
6705 case RETURN_ERROR:
6706 switch (e.error)
6707 {
6708 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
6709
6710 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
6711 error. */
6712
6713 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
6714 throw_exception (e);
6715
6716 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
6717
6718 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
6719 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
6720 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
6721 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
6722 return;
6723
6724 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
6725 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
6726 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
6727 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
6728 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
6729 addr_string = &copy_arg;
6730 sals.nelts = 1;
6731 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
6732 pending_sal.pc = 0;
6733 pending = 1;
6734 break;
6735 default:
6736 throw_exception (e);
6737 }
6738 default:
6739 if (!sals.nelts)
6740 return;
6741 }
6742
6743 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
6744 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6745
6746 if (!pending)
6747 {
6748 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
6749 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
6750
6751 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
6752 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
6753 }
6754
6755 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
6756 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
6757 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
6758 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
6759 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6760
6761 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
6762 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
6763 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
6764 {
6765 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
6766 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
6767 }
6768
6769 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
6770 are ok for the target. */
6771 if (!pending)
6772 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
6773
6774 type_wanted = (traceflag
6775 ? bp_tracepoint
6776 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
6777
6778 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
6779 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
6780 breakpoint. */
6781 if (!pending)
6782 {
6783 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
6784 {
6785 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
6786 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
6787 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
6788 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
6789 cond_string = NULL;
6790 thread = -1;
6791 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
6792 &thread, &task);
6793 if (cond_string)
6794 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6795 }
6796 else
6797 {
6798 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
6799 if (cond_string)
6800 {
6801 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
6802 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6803 }
6804 }
6805 create_breakpoints (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string, type_wanted,
6806 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
6807 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6808 }
6809 else
6810 {
6811 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
6812 struct breakpoint *b;
6813
6814 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
6815
6816 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
6817 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6818 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6819 b->thread = -1;
6820 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
6821 b->cond_string = NULL;
6822 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6823 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6824 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
6825 b->ops = ops;
6826 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6827 b->pspace = current_program_space;
6828
6829 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6830 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6831 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6832 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6833
6834 mention (b);
6835 }
6836
6837 if (sals.nelts > 1)
6838 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
6839 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
6840 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
6841 breakpoint. */
6842 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6843 /* But cleanup everything else. */
6844 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6845
6846 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
6847 update_global_location_list (1);
6848 }
6849
6850 /* Set a breakpoint.
6851 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
6852 condition, and thread.
6853 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
6854 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
6855 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
6856
6857 static void
6858 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
6859 {
6860 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
6861 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
6862
6863 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
6864 arg,
6865 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
6866 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6867 0 /* Ignore count */,
6868 pending_break_support,
6869 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
6870 from_tty,
6871 1 /* enabled */);
6872 }
6873
6874
6875 void
6876 set_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6877 char *address, char *condition,
6878 int hardwareflag, int tempflag,
6879 int thread, int ignore_count,
6880 int pending, int enabled)
6881 {
6882 break_command_really (gdbarch,
6883 address, condition, thread,
6884 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
6885 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6886 ignore_count,
6887 pending
6888 ? AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE : AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE,
6889 NULL, 0, enabled);
6890 }
6891
6892 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
6893 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
6894 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
6895 not modified.
6896
6897 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
6898
6899 static void
6900 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6901 {
6902 struct symbol *sym;
6903 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
6904 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6905
6906 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6907
6908 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
6909 if (sym != NULL)
6910 {
6911 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6912 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
6913 {
6914 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
6915 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
6916 *sal = start_sal;
6917 }
6918 }
6919
6920 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6921 }
6922
6923 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
6924
6925 void
6926 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6927 {
6928 CORE_ADDR pc;
6929
6930 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6931 {
6932 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
6933 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
6934 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
6935 sal->pc = pc;
6936
6937 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
6938 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6939 if (sal->explicit_line)
6940 {
6941 /* Preserve the original line number. */
6942 int saved_line = sal->line;
6943 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
6944 sal->line = saved_line;
6945 }
6946 }
6947
6948 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6949 {
6950 struct blockvector *bv;
6951 struct block *b;
6952 struct symbol *sym;
6953
6954 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
6955 if (bv != NULL)
6956 {
6957 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
6958 if (sym != NULL)
6959 {
6960 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
6961 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
6962 }
6963 else
6964 {
6965 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
6966 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
6967 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
6968 source). */
6969
6970 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
6971 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6972
6973 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
6974
6975 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
6976 if (msym)
6977 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
6978
6979 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6980 }
6981 }
6982 }
6983 }
6984
6985 void
6986 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6987 {
6988 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
6989 }
6990
6991 void
6992 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6993 {
6994 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
6995 }
6996
6997 static void
6998 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6999 {
7000 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7001 }
7002
7003 static void
7004 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7005 {
7006 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7007 }
7008
7009 static void
7010 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7011 {
7012 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7013 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7014 stop at <line>\n"));
7015 }
7016
7017 static void
7018 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7019 {
7020 int badInput = 0;
7021
7022 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7023 badInput = 1;
7024 else if (*arg != '*')
7025 {
7026 char *argptr = arg;
7027 int hasColon = 0;
7028
7029 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7030 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7031 function/method name */
7032 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7033 {
7034 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7035 argptr++;
7036 }
7037
7038 if (hasColon)
7039 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7040 else
7041 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7042 }
7043
7044 if (badInput)
7045 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7046 else
7047 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7048 }
7049
7050 static void
7051 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7052 {
7053 int badInput = 0;
7054
7055 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7056 badInput = 1;
7057 else
7058 {
7059 char *argptr = arg;
7060 int hasColon = 0;
7061
7062 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7063 it is probably a line number. */
7064 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7065 {
7066 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7067 argptr++;
7068 }
7069
7070 if (hasColon)
7071 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7072 else
7073 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7074 }
7075
7076 if (badInput)
7077 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7078 else
7079 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7080 }
7081
7082 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7083 hw_read: watch read,
7084 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7085 static void
7086 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7087 {
7088 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7089 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7090 struct expression *exp;
7091 struct block *exp_valid_block;
7092 struct value *val, *mark;
7093 struct frame_info *frame;
7094 char *exp_start = NULL;
7095 char *exp_end = NULL;
7096 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7097 int toklen;
7098 char *cond_start = NULL;
7099 char *cond_end = NULL;
7100 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7101 enum bptype bp_type;
7102 int mem_cnt = 0;
7103 int thread = -1;
7104
7105 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7106 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7107 {
7108 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7109
7110 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7111 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7112
7113 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7114 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7115 be the thread identifier. */
7116 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7117 tok--;
7118 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7119 tok--;
7120
7121 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7122 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7123
7124 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7125 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7126 reach a "thread" token. */
7127 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7128 tok--;
7129
7130 end_tok = tok;
7131
7132 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7133 tok--;
7134
7135 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7136 calculate the length of the token. */
7137 tok++;
7138 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7139
7140 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7141 {
7142 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7143 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7144 only in a specific thread. */
7145 char *endp;
7146
7147 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7148 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7149
7150 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7151 thread ID. */
7152 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7153 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7154
7155 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7156 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7157 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7158
7159 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7160 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7161 evaluate_expression() function. */
7162 *tok = '\0';
7163 }
7164 }
7165
7166 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7167 innermost_block = NULL;
7168 exp_start = arg;
7169 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7170 exp_end = arg;
7171 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7172 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7173 prettier. */
7174 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7175 --exp_end;
7176
7177 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7178 mark = value_mark ();
7179 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7180 if (val != NULL)
7181 release_value (val);
7182
7183 tok = arg;
7184 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7185 tok++;
7186 end_tok = tok;
7187
7188 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7189 end_tok++;
7190
7191 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7192 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7193 {
7194 struct expression *cond;
7195
7196 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7197 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7198 xfree (cond);
7199 cond_end = tok;
7200 }
7201 if (*tok)
7202 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7203
7204 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7205 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7206 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7207 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7208 else
7209 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7210
7211 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7212 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7213 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7214 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7215 {
7216 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7217 target_resources_ok =
7218 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7219 other_type_used);
7220 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7221 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7222
7223 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7224 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7225 }
7226
7227 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7228 watchpoint could not be set. */
7229 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7230 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7231
7232 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7233
7234 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7235 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7236 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7237 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7238 if (innermost_block && frame)
7239 {
7240 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7241 {
7242 scope_breakpoint
7243 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7244 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7245 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7246
7247 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7248
7249 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7250 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7251
7252 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7253 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7254
7255 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7256 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7257 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7258 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7259 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7260 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7261 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7262 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7263 scope_breakpoint->type);
7264 }
7265 }
7266
7267 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7268 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7269 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7270 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7271 b->thread = thread;
7272 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7273 b->exp = exp;
7274 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7275 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7276 b->val = val;
7277 b->val_valid = 1;
7278 if (cond_start)
7279 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7280 else
7281 b->cond_string = 0;
7282
7283 if (frame)
7284 {
7285 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7286 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7287 }
7288 else
7289 {
7290 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7291 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7292 }
7293
7294 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7295 {
7296 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7297 need to act on them together. */
7298 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7299 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7300 }
7301
7302 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7303
7304 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7305 that should be inserted. */
7306 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7307
7308 mention (b);
7309 update_global_location_list (1);
7310 }
7311
7312 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7313 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7314 in hardware return zero. */
7315
7316 static int
7317 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7318 {
7319 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7320 struct value *head = v;
7321
7322 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7323 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7324 return 0;
7325
7326 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7327 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7328 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7329 hardware watchpoint.
7330
7331 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7332 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7333 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7334 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7335 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7336 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7337 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7338 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7339 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7340
7341 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7342 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7343 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7344 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7345 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7346 {
7347 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7348 {
7349 if (value_lazy (v))
7350 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7351 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7352 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7353 ;
7354 else
7355 {
7356 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7357 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7358 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7359
7360 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7361 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7362 middle of some value chain. */
7363 if (v == head
7364 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7365 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7366 {
7367 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7368 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7369
7370 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7371 return 0;
7372 else
7373 found_memory_cnt++;
7374 }
7375 }
7376 }
7377 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7378 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7379 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7380 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7381 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7382 }
7383
7384 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7385 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7386 return found_memory_cnt;
7387 }
7388
7389 void
7390 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7391 {
7392 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7393 }
7394
7395 static void
7396 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7397 {
7398 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7399 }
7400
7401 void
7402 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7403 {
7404 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7405 }
7406
7407 static void
7408 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7409 {
7410 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7411 }
7412
7413 void
7414 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7415 {
7416 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7417 }
7418
7419 static void
7420 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7421 {
7422 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7423 }
7424 \f
7425
7426 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7427 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7428
7429 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7430 {
7431 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7432 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7433 };
7434
7435 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7436 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7437 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7438 command. */
7439 static void
7440 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7441 {
7442 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7443
7444 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7445 if (a->breakpoint2)
7446 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7447 }
7448
7449 void
7450 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7451 {
7452 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7453 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7454 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7455 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7456 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7457 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7458
7459 clear_proceed_status ();
7460
7461 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7462 this function */
7463
7464 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7465 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7466 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7467 else
7468 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7469 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7470
7471 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7472 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7473
7474 sal = sals.sals[0];
7475 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7476
7477 if (*arg)
7478 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7479
7480 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7481
7482 if (anywhere)
7483 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7484 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7485 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7486 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7487 else
7488 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7489 at the very same frame. */
7490 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7491 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7492 bp_until);
7493
7494 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7495
7496 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7497 one. */
7498
7499 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7500 {
7501 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7502 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7503 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7504 sal,
7505 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7506 bp_until);
7507 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7508 }
7509
7510 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7511
7512 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7513 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7514 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7515 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7516
7517 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7518 {
7519 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7520 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7521
7522 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7523 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7524
7525 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7526 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7527 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7528 xfree);
7529 }
7530 else
7531 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7532 }
7533
7534 static void
7535 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7536 {
7537 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7538 return;
7539 while (isspace (**s))
7540 *s += 1;
7541 }
7542
7543 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7544 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7545
7546 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7547 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7548 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7549 if clause in the arg string. */
7550
7551 static char *
7552 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7553 {
7554 char *cond_string;
7555
7556 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7557 return NULL;
7558
7559 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7560 (*arg) += 2;
7561
7562 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7563 condition string. */
7564 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7565 cond_string = *arg;
7566
7567 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7568 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7569
7570 return cond_string;
7571 }
7572
7573 /* This function attempts to parse an optional filename from the arg
7574 string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7575
7576 Else, it returns a pointer to the parsed filename. (This function
7577 makes no attempt to verify that a file of that name exists, or is
7578 accessible.) And, it updates arg to point to the first character
7579 following the parsed filename in the arg string.
7580
7581 Note that clients needing to preserve the returned filename for
7582 future access should copy it to their own buffers. */
7583 static char *
7584 ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg)
7585 {
7586 static char filename[1024];
7587 char *arg_p = *arg;
7588 int i;
7589 char c;
7590
7591 if ((*arg_p == '\0') || isspace (*arg_p))
7592 return NULL;
7593
7594 for (i = 0;; i++)
7595 {
7596 c = *arg_p;
7597 if (isspace (c))
7598 c = '\0';
7599 filename[i] = c;
7600 if (c == '\0')
7601 break;
7602 arg_p++;
7603 }
7604 *arg = arg_p;
7605
7606 return filename;
7607 }
7608
7609 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7610 process start/exit, etc. */
7611
7612 typedef enum
7613 {
7614 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7615 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7616 }
7617 catch_fork_kind;
7618
7619 static void
7620 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7621 {
7622 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7623 char *cond_string = NULL;
7624 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7625 int tempflag;
7626
7627 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7628 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7629 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7630
7631 if (!arg)
7632 arg = "";
7633 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7634
7635 /* The allowed syntax is:
7636 catch [v]fork
7637 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7638
7639 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7640 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7641
7642 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7643 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7644
7645 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7646 and enable reporting of such events. */
7647 switch (fork_kind)
7648 {
7649 case catch_fork_temporary:
7650 case catch_fork_permanent:
7651 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7652 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7653 break;
7654 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7655 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7656 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7657 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7658 break;
7659 default:
7660 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7661 break;
7662 }
7663 }
7664
7665 static void
7666 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7667 {
7668 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7669 int tempflag;
7670 char *cond_string = NULL;
7671
7672 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7673
7674 if (!arg)
7675 arg = "";
7676 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7677
7678 /* The allowed syntax is:
7679 catch exec
7680 catch exec if <cond>
7681
7682 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7683 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7684
7685 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7686 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7687
7688 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7689 and enable reporting of such events. */
7690 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7691 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7692 }
7693
7694 static enum print_stop_action
7695 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7696 {
7697 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7698
7699 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7700
7701 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7702 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7703 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7704 b->loc->address,
7705 b->number, 1);
7706 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7707 ui_out_text (uiout,
7708 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7709 : "Catchpoint ");
7710 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7711 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7712 ui_out_text (uiout,
7713 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7714 : " (exception caught), ");
7715 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7716 {
7717 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7718 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7719 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7720 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7721 }
7722 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7723 }
7724
7725 static void
7726 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7727 {
7728 struct value_print_options opts;
7729 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7730 if (opts.addressprint)
7731 {
7732 annotate_field (4);
7733 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7734 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7735 else
7736 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7737 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7738 }
7739 annotate_field (5);
7740 if (b->loc)
7741 *last_loc = b->loc;
7742 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
7743 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
7744 else
7745 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
7746 }
7747
7748 static void
7749 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7750 {
7751 int bp_temp;
7752 int bp_throw;
7753
7754 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7755 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7756 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
7757 : _("Catchpoint "));
7758 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7759 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
7760 : _(" (catch)"));
7761 }
7762
7763 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
7764 NULL, /* insert */
7765 NULL, /* remove */
7766 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
7767 print_exception_catchpoint,
7768 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
7769 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
7770 };
7771
7772 static int
7773 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
7774 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
7775 {
7776 char *trigger_func_name;
7777
7778 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7779 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
7780 else
7781 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
7782
7783 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7784 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
7785 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
7786 tempflag, 0, 0,
7787 0,
7788 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
7789 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
7790 1 /* enabled */);
7791
7792 return 1;
7793 }
7794
7795 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
7796
7797 static void
7798 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
7799 int tempflag, int from_tty)
7800 {
7801 char *cond_string = NULL;
7802 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
7803
7804 if (!arg)
7805 arg = "";
7806 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7807
7808 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7809
7810 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7811 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7812
7813 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
7814 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7815 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
7816
7817 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
7818 return;
7819
7820 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
7821 }
7822
7823 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
7824
7825 static void
7826 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7827 {
7828 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7829 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7830 }
7831
7832 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
7833
7834 static void
7835 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7836 {
7837 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7838 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7839 }
7840
7841 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
7842
7843 static void
7844 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7845 struct symtab_and_line sal,
7846 char *addr_string,
7847 char *exp_string,
7848 char *cond_string,
7849 struct expression *cond,
7850 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7851 int tempflag,
7852 int from_tty)
7853 {
7854 struct breakpoint *b;
7855
7856 if (from_tty)
7857 {
7858 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7859 if (!loc_gdbarch)
7860 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7861
7862 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7863 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
7864 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
7865 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
7866 used for different exception names will use the same address.
7867 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
7868 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
7869 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
7870 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
7871 enough for now, though. */
7872 }
7873
7874 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
7875 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7876
7877 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7878 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7879 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7880 b->ignore_count = 0;
7881 b->loc->cond = cond;
7882 b->addr_string = addr_string;
7883 b->language = language_ada;
7884 b->cond_string = cond_string;
7885 b->exp_string = exp_string;
7886 b->thread = -1;
7887 b->ops = ops;
7888
7889 mention (b);
7890 update_global_location_list (1);
7891 }
7892
7893 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
7894
7895 static void
7896 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
7897 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7898 {
7899 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7900 int tempflag;
7901 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7902 enum bptype type;
7903 char *addr_string = NULL;
7904 char *exp_string = NULL;
7905 char *cond_string = NULL;
7906 struct expression *cond = NULL;
7907 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
7908
7909 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7910
7911 if (!arg)
7912 arg = "";
7913 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
7914 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
7915 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
7916 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
7917 from_tty);
7918 }
7919
7920 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
7921 static void
7922 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
7923 {
7924 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
7925 VEC_free (int, iter);
7926 }
7927
7928 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
7929 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
7930 static VEC(int) *
7931 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
7932 {
7933 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
7934 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
7935
7936 while (*arg != '\0')
7937 {
7938 int i, syscall_number;
7939 char *endptr;
7940 char cur_name[128];
7941 struct syscall s;
7942
7943 /* Skip whitespace. */
7944 while (isspace (*arg))
7945 arg++;
7946
7947 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
7948 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
7949 cur_name[i] = '\0';
7950 arg += i;
7951
7952 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
7953 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
7954 if (*endptr == '\0')
7955 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
7956 else
7957 {
7958 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
7959 to a number. */
7960 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
7961
7962 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
7963 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
7964 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
7965 be caught. */
7966 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
7967 }
7968
7969 /* Ok, it's valid. */
7970 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
7971 }
7972
7973 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
7974 return result;
7975 }
7976
7977 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
7978
7979 static void
7980 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7981 {
7982 int tempflag;
7983 VEC(int) *filter;
7984 struct syscall s;
7985 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7986
7987 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
7988 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
7989 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
7990 this architeture yet."));
7991
7992 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7993
7994 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7995
7996 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
7997 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
7998 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
7999 for his/her architecture. */
8000 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8001
8002 /* The allowed syntax is:
8003 catch syscall
8004 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8005
8006 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8007
8008 if (arg != NULL)
8009 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8010 else
8011 filter = NULL;
8012
8013 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8014 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8015 }
8016
8017 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8018
8019 static void
8020 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8021 {
8022 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8023 int tempflag;
8024 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8025 char *addr_string = NULL;
8026 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8027
8028 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8029
8030 if (!arg)
8031 arg = "";
8032 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8033 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8034 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8035 }
8036
8037 static void
8038 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8039 {
8040 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8041 }
8042 \f
8043
8044 static void
8045 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8046 {
8047 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8048 }
8049
8050 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8051
8052 static void
8053 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8054 {
8055 struct breakpoint *b;
8056 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8057 int ix;
8058 int default_match;
8059 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8060 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8061 int i;
8062
8063 if (arg)
8064 {
8065 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8066 default_match = 0;
8067 }
8068 else
8069 {
8070 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8071 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8072 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8073 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8074 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8075 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8076 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8077 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8078 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8079 error (_("No source file specified."));
8080
8081 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8082 sals.nelts = 1;
8083
8084 default_match = 1;
8085 }
8086
8087 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8088 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8089 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8090 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8091 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8092
8093 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8094 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8095 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8096 due to optimization, all in one block.
8097 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8098 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8099 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8100 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8101 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8102 to support that. */
8103
8104 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8105 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8106 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8107 one breakpoint. */
8108
8109 found = NULL;
8110 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8111 {
8112 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8113 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8114 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8115 or at default pc.
8116
8117 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8118
8119 0 1 pc
8120 1 1 pc _and_ line
8121 0 0 line
8122 1 0 <can't happen> */
8123
8124 sal = sals.sals[i];
8125
8126 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8127 'found'. */
8128 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8129 {
8130 int match = 0;
8131 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8132 if (b->type != bp_none
8133 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8134 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8135 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8136 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8137 {
8138 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8139 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8140 {
8141 int pc_match = sal.pc
8142 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8143 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8144 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8145 || loc->section == sal.section);
8146 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8147 && b->source_file != NULL
8148 && sal.symtab != NULL
8149 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8150 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8151 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8152 if (pc_match || line_match)
8153 {
8154 match = 1;
8155 break;
8156 }
8157 }
8158 }
8159
8160 if (match)
8161 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8162 }
8163 }
8164 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8165 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8166 {
8167 if (arg)
8168 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8169 else
8170 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8171 }
8172
8173 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8174 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8175 if (from_tty)
8176 {
8177 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8178 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8179 else
8180 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8181 }
8182 breakpoints_changed ();
8183
8184 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8185 {
8186 if (from_tty)
8187 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8188 delete_breakpoint (b);
8189 }
8190 if (from_tty)
8191 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8192 }
8193 \f
8194 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8195 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8196 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8197
8198 void
8199 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8200 {
8201 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8202
8203 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8204 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8205 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8206 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8207 && bs->stop)
8208 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8209
8210 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8211 {
8212 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8213 delete_breakpoint (b);
8214 }
8215 }
8216
8217 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8218 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8219 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8220 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8221 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8222
8223 static int
8224 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8225 {
8226 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8227 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8228 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8229 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8230
8231 if (a->address != b->address)
8232 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8233
8234 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8235 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8236 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8237
8238 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8239 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8240
8241 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8242 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8243 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8244
8245 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8246 }
8247
8248 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8249 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8250 the bp_location array. */
8251
8252 static void
8253 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8254 {
8255 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8256
8257 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8258 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8259
8260 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8261 {
8262 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8263
8264 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8265 continue;
8266
8267 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8268 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8269
8270 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8271 addr = bl->address - start;
8272 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8273 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8274
8275 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8276
8277 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8278 addr = end - bl->address;
8279 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8280 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8281 }
8282 }
8283
8284 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8285 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8286 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8287 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8288 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8289 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8290 returns true on them.
8291
8292 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8293 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8294 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8295 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8296 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8297 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8298
8299 static void
8300 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8301 {
8302 struct breakpoint *b;
8303 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8304 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8305
8306 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8307 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8308 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8309 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8310 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8311 once. */
8312 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8313 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8314 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8315 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8316
8317 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8318 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8319 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8320 unsigned old_location_count;
8321
8322 old_location = bp_location;
8323 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8324 bp_location = NULL;
8325 bp_location_count = 0;
8326 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8327
8328 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8329 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8330 bp_location_count++;
8331
8332 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8333 locp = bp_location;
8334 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8335 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8336 *locp++ = loc;
8337 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8338 bp_location_compare);
8339
8340 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8341
8342 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8343 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8344 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8345 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8346 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8347
8348 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8349 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8350
8351 locp = bp_location;
8352 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8353 old_locp++)
8354 {
8355 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8356 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8357
8358 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8359 have to free it. */
8360 int found_object = 0;
8361 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8362 int keep_in_target = 0;
8363 int removed = 0;
8364
8365 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8366 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8367 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8368 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8369 locp++;
8370
8371 for (loc2p = locp;
8372 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8373 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8374 loc2p++)
8375 {
8376 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8377 {
8378 found_object = 1;
8379 break;
8380 }
8381 }
8382
8383 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8384 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8385 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8386 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8387 inserted. */
8388
8389 if (old_loc->inserted)
8390 {
8391 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8392
8393 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8394 {
8395 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8396 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8397 keep_in_target = 1;
8398 }
8399 else
8400 {
8401 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8402 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8403 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8404
8405 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8406 {
8407 for (loc2p = locp;
8408 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8409 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8410 loc2p++)
8411 {
8412 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8413
8414 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8415 {
8416 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8417 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8418 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8419 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8420 {
8421 loc2->inserted = 1;
8422 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8423 keep_in_target = 1;
8424 break;
8425 }
8426 }
8427 }
8428 }
8429 }
8430
8431 if (!keep_in_target)
8432 {
8433 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8434 {
8435 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8436 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8437 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8438 succeed next time.
8439
8440 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8441 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8442 after calling us. */
8443 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8444 old_loc->owner->number);
8445 }
8446 removed = 1;
8447 }
8448 }
8449
8450 if (!found_object)
8451 {
8452 if (removed && non_stop
8453 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8454 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8455 {
8456 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8457 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8458 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8459 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8460 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8461 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8462 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8463 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8464 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8465 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8466 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8467 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8468 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8469 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8470 SIGTRAP.
8471
8472 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8473 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8474
8475 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8476 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8477 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8478 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8479 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8480 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8481 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8482 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8483 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8484 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8485 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8486 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8487 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8488 thread_count.
8489
8490 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8491 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8492 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8493 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8494
8495 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8496 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8497 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8498 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8499 traps we can no longer explain. */
8500
8501 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8502 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8503
8504 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8505 }
8506 else
8507 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8508 }
8509 }
8510
8511 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8512 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8513 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8514 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8515 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8516 are sorted first for the same address.
8517
8518 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8519 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8520
8521 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8522 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8523 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8524 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8525 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8526 {
8527 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8528 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8529
8530 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8531 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8532 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8533 || !loc->enabled
8534 || loc->shlib_disabled
8535 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b))
8536 continue;
8537
8538 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8539 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8540 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8541 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8542 "actually inserted"));
8543
8544 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8545 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8546 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8547 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8548 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8549 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8550 else
8551 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8552
8553 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8554 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8555 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8556 {
8557 *loc_first_p = loc;
8558 loc->duplicate = 0;
8559 continue;
8560 }
8561
8562 loc->duplicate = 1;
8563
8564 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8565 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8566 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8567 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8568 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8569 }
8570
8571 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8572 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8573 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8574 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8575
8576 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8577 }
8578
8579 void
8580 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8581 {
8582 struct bp_location *loc;
8583 int ix;
8584
8585 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8586 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8587 {
8588 free_bp_location (loc);
8589 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8590 --ix;
8591 }
8592 }
8593
8594 static void
8595 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8596 {
8597 struct gdb_exception e;
8598 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8599 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8600 }
8601
8602 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8603 static void
8604 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8605 {
8606 bpstat bs;
8607 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8608 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8609 {
8610 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8611 bs->old_val = NULL;
8612 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8613 }
8614 }
8615
8616 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8617 static int
8618 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8619 {
8620 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8621 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8622 return 0;
8623 }
8624
8625 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8626 structures. */
8627
8628 void
8629 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8630 {
8631 struct breakpoint *b;
8632 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8633
8634 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8635
8636 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8637 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8638
8639 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8640 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8641 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8642 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8643 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8644
8645 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8646 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8647 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8648 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8649 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8650 return;
8651
8652 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8653
8654 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8655 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8656
8657 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8658 if (b->next == bpt)
8659 {
8660 b->next = bpt->next;
8661 break;
8662 }
8663
8664 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8665 if (bpt->cond_string != NULL)
8666 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8667 if (bpt->addr_string != NULL)
8668 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8669 if (bpt->exp != NULL)
8670 xfree (bpt->exp);
8671 if (bpt->exp_string != NULL)
8672 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8673 if (bpt->val != NULL)
8674 value_free (bpt->val);
8675 if (bpt->source_file != NULL)
8676 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8677 if (bpt->exec_pathname != NULL)
8678 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8679 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8680
8681 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8682 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8683 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8684 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8685 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8686 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8687 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8688 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8689 with commands won't work. */
8690
8691 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8692
8693 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8694 list, update the global location list. This
8695 will remove locations that used to belong to
8696 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8697 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8698 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8699 design to have location completely self-contained,
8700 but it's not the case now. */
8701 update_global_location_list (0);
8702
8703
8704 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8705 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8706 bpt->type = bp_none;
8707
8708 xfree (bpt);
8709 }
8710
8711 static void
8712 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8713 {
8714 delete_breakpoint (b);
8715 }
8716
8717 struct cleanup *
8718 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8719 {
8720 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8721 }
8722
8723 void
8724 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8725 {
8726 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8727
8728 dont_repeat ();
8729
8730 if (arg == 0)
8731 {
8732 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
8733
8734 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
8735 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
8736 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
8737 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8738 {
8739 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8740 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8741 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8742 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8743 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8744 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8745 && b->number >= 0)
8746 {
8747 breaks_to_delete = 1;
8748 break;
8749 }
8750 }
8751
8752 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
8753 if (!from_tty
8754 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
8755 {
8756 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8757 {
8758 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8759 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8760 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8761 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8762 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8763 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8764 && b->number >= 0)
8765 delete_breakpoint (b);
8766 }
8767 }
8768 }
8769 else
8770 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
8771 }
8772
8773 static int
8774 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
8775 {
8776 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8777 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
8778 return 0;
8779 return 1;
8780 }
8781
8782 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
8783 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
8784 Null names are ignored. */
8785
8786 static int
8787 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
8788 {
8789 struct bp_location *l;
8790 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
8791 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
8792 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
8793
8794 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
8795 {
8796 const char **slot;
8797 const char *name = l->function_name;
8798
8799 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
8800 if (name == NULL)
8801 continue;
8802
8803 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
8804 INSERT);
8805 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
8806 NULL. */
8807 if (*slot != NULL)
8808 {
8809 htab_delete (htab);
8810 return 1;
8811 }
8812 *slot = name;
8813 }
8814
8815 htab_delete (htab);
8816 return 0;
8817 }
8818
8819 static void
8820 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
8821 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
8822 {
8823 int i;
8824 char *s;
8825 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
8826
8827 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
8828 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
8829 the common case where all locations are in the same
8830 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
8831 retain the location, so that when the library
8832 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
8833 status of the individual locations. */
8834 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
8835 return;
8836
8837 b->loc = NULL;
8838
8839 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
8840 {
8841 struct bp_location *new_loc =
8842 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
8843
8844 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
8845 old symtab. */
8846 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
8847 {
8848 struct gdb_exception e;
8849
8850 s = b->cond_string;
8851 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8852 {
8853 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
8854 0);
8855 }
8856 if (e.reason < 0)
8857 {
8858 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
8859 b->number, e.message);
8860 new_loc->enabled = 0;
8861 }
8862 }
8863
8864 if (b->source_file != NULL)
8865 xfree (b->source_file);
8866 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
8867 b->source_file = NULL;
8868 else
8869 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
8870
8871 if (b->line_number == 0)
8872 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
8873 }
8874
8875 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
8876 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
8877 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
8878
8879 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
8880 {
8881 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
8882 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
8883 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
8884 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
8885 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
8886 often enough until a better solution is found. */
8887 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
8888
8889 for (; e; e = e->next)
8890 {
8891 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
8892 {
8893 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
8894 if (have_ambiguous_names)
8895 {
8896 for (; l; l = l->next)
8897 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
8898 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
8899 {
8900 l->enabled = 0;
8901 break;
8902 }
8903 }
8904 else
8905 {
8906 for (; l; l = l->next)
8907 if (l->function_name
8908 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
8909 {
8910 l->enabled = 0;
8911 break;
8912 }
8913 }
8914 }
8915 }
8916 }
8917
8918 update_global_location_list (1);
8919 }
8920
8921
8922 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
8923 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
8924 Unused in this case. */
8925
8926 static int
8927 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
8928 {
8929 /* get past catch_errs */
8930 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
8931 struct value *mark;
8932 int i;
8933 int not_found = 0;
8934 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
8935 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
8936 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
8937 char *s;
8938 enum enable_state save_enable;
8939 struct gdb_exception e;
8940 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
8941
8942 switch (b->type)
8943 {
8944 case bp_none:
8945 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
8946 b->number);
8947 return 0;
8948 case bp_breakpoint:
8949 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
8950 case bp_tracepoint:
8951 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
8952 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
8953 return 0;
8954
8955 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
8956 {
8957 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
8958 delete_breakpoint (b);
8959 return 0;
8960 }
8961
8962 set_language (b->language);
8963 input_radix = b->input_radix;
8964 s = b->addr_string;
8965
8966 save_current_space_and_thread ();
8967 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
8968
8969 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8970 {
8971 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
8972 not_found_ptr);
8973 }
8974 if (e.reason < 0)
8975 {
8976 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
8977 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
8978 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
8979 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
8980 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
8981 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
8982 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
8983 if (not_found
8984 && (b->condition_not_parsed
8985 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
8986 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
8987 not_found_and_ok = 1;
8988
8989 if (!not_found_and_ok)
8990 {
8991 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
8992 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
8993 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
8994 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
8995 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
8996 which approach is better. */
8997 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
8998 throw_exception (e);
8999 }
9000 }
9001
9002 if (!not_found)
9003 {
9004 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9005
9006 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9007 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9008 {
9009 char *cond_string = 0;
9010 int thread = -1;
9011 int task = 0;
9012
9013 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9014 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9015 if (cond_string)
9016 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9017 b->thread = thread;
9018 b->task = task;
9019 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9020 }
9021
9022 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9023 }
9024
9025 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9026 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9027 break;
9028
9029 case bp_watchpoint:
9030 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9031 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9032 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9033 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9034 or it can be on local variables.
9035
9036 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9037 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9038 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9039 and unloaded.
9040
9041 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9042 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9043 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9044 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9045 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9046 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9047
9048 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9049 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9050 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9051 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9052
9053 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9054 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9055
9056 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9057 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9058 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9059 break;
9060 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9061 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9062 loaded. */
9063 case bp_catchpoint:
9064 break;
9065
9066 default:
9067 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9068 /* fall through */
9069 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9070 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9071 case bp_overlay_event:
9072 case bp_longjmp_master:
9073 delete_breakpoint (b);
9074 break;
9075
9076 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9077 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9078 case bp_shlib_event:
9079
9080 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9081 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9082 case bp_thread_event:
9083
9084 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9085 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9086 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9087 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9088 case bp_until:
9089 case bp_finish:
9090 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9091 case bp_call_dummy:
9092 case bp_step_resume:
9093 case bp_longjmp:
9094 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9095 case bp_jit_event:
9096 break;
9097 }
9098
9099 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9100 return 0;
9101 }
9102
9103 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9104 void
9105 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9106 {
9107 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9108 enum language save_language;
9109 int save_input_radix;
9110 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9111
9112 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9113 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9114 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9115
9116 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9117 {
9118 /* Format possible error msg */
9119 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9120 b->number);
9121 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9122 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9123 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9124 }
9125 set_language (save_language);
9126 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9127
9128 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9129
9130 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9131
9132 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9133 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9134 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9135 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9136 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9137 }
9138 \f
9139 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9140
9141 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9142 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9143 void
9144 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9145 {
9146 if (b->thread != -1)
9147 {
9148 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9149 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9150
9151 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9152 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9153 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9154 as well. */
9155 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9156 }
9157 }
9158
9159 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9160 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9161 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9162
9163 void
9164 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9165 {
9166 struct breakpoint *b;
9167
9168 if (count < 0)
9169 count = 0;
9170
9171 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9172 if (b->number == bptnum)
9173 {
9174 b->ignore_count = count;
9175 if (from_tty)
9176 {
9177 if (count == 0)
9178 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9179 bptnum);
9180 else if (count == 1)
9181 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9182 bptnum);
9183 else
9184 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9185 count, bptnum);
9186 }
9187 breakpoints_changed ();
9188 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9189 return;
9190 }
9191
9192 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9193 }
9194
9195 void
9196 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9197 {
9198 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9199 b->silent = 1;
9200 }
9201
9202 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9203
9204 static void
9205 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9206 {
9207 char *p = args;
9208 int num;
9209
9210 if (p == 0)
9211 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9212
9213 num = get_number (&p);
9214 if (num == 0)
9215 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9216 if (*p == 0)
9217 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9218
9219 set_ignore_count (num,
9220 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9221 from_tty);
9222 if (from_tty)
9223 printf_filtered ("\n");
9224 }
9225 \f
9226 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9227 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9228
9229 static void
9230 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9231 {
9232 char *p = args;
9233 char *p1;
9234 int num;
9235 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9236 int match;
9237
9238 if (p == 0)
9239 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9240
9241 while (*p)
9242 {
9243 match = 0;
9244 p1 = p;
9245
9246 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9247 if (num == 0)
9248 {
9249 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9250 }
9251 else
9252 {
9253 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9254 if (b->number == num)
9255 {
9256 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9257 match = 1;
9258 function (b);
9259 if (related_breakpoint)
9260 function (related_breakpoint);
9261 break;
9262 }
9263 if (match == 0)
9264 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9265 }
9266 p = p1;
9267 }
9268 }
9269
9270 static struct bp_location *
9271 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9272 {
9273 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9274 char *p1;
9275 int bp_num;
9276 int loc_num;
9277 struct breakpoint *b;
9278 struct bp_location *loc;
9279
9280 *dot = '\0';
9281
9282 p1 = number;
9283 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9284 if (bp_num == 0)
9285 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9286
9287 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9288 if (b->number == bp_num)
9289 {
9290 break;
9291 }
9292
9293 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9294 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9295
9296 p1 = dot+1;
9297 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9298 if (loc_num == 0)
9299 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9300
9301 --loc_num;
9302 loc = b->loc;
9303 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9304 ;
9305 if (!loc)
9306 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9307
9308 return loc;
9309 }
9310
9311
9312 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9313 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9314 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9315
9316 void
9317 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9318 {
9319 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9320 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9321 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9322 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9323 return;
9324
9325 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9326 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9327 return;
9328
9329 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9330
9331 update_global_location_list (0);
9332
9333 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9334 }
9335
9336 static void
9337 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9338 {
9339 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9340 if (args == 0)
9341 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9342 switch (bpt->type)
9343 {
9344 case bp_none:
9345 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9346 bpt->number);
9347 continue;
9348 case bp_breakpoint:
9349 case bp_tracepoint:
9350 case bp_catchpoint:
9351 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9352 case bp_watchpoint:
9353 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9354 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9355 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9356 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9357 default:
9358 continue;
9359 }
9360 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9361 {
9362 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9363 if (loc)
9364 loc->enabled = 0;
9365 update_global_location_list (0);
9366 }
9367 else
9368 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9369 }
9370
9371 static void
9372 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9373 {
9374 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9375 struct value *mark;
9376
9377 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9378 {
9379 int i;
9380 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9381 target_resources_ok =
9382 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9383 i + 1, 0);
9384 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9385 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9386 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9387 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9388 }
9389
9390 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9391 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9392 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9393 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9394 {
9395 struct gdb_exception e;
9396
9397 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9398 {
9399 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9400 }
9401 if (e.reason < 0)
9402 {
9403 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9404 bpt->number);
9405 return;
9406 }
9407 }
9408
9409 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9410 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9411 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9412 update_global_location_list (1);
9413 breakpoints_changed ();
9414
9415 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9416 }
9417
9418
9419 void
9420 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9421 {
9422 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9423 }
9424
9425 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9426 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9427 in stopping the inferior. */
9428
9429 static void
9430 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9431 {
9432 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9433 if (args == 0)
9434 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9435 switch (bpt->type)
9436 {
9437 case bp_none:
9438 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9439 bpt->number);
9440 continue;
9441 case bp_breakpoint:
9442 case bp_tracepoint:
9443 case bp_catchpoint:
9444 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9445 case bp_watchpoint:
9446 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9447 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9448 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9449 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9450 default:
9451 continue;
9452 }
9453 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9454 {
9455 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9456 if (loc)
9457 loc->enabled = 1;
9458 update_global_location_list (1);
9459 }
9460 else
9461 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9462 }
9463
9464 static void
9465 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9466 {
9467 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9468 }
9469
9470 static void
9471 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9472 {
9473 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9474 }
9475
9476 static void
9477 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9478 {
9479 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9480 }
9481
9482 static void
9483 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9484 {
9485 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9486 }
9487 \f
9488 static void
9489 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9490 {
9491 }
9492
9493 static void
9494 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9495 {
9496 }
9497
9498 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9499 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9500 GDB itself. */
9501
9502 static void
9503 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9504 const bfd_byte *data)
9505 {
9506 struct breakpoint *bp;
9507
9508 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9509 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9510 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9511 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9512 {
9513 struct bp_location *loc;
9514
9515 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9516 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9517 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9518 && addr + len > loc->address)
9519 {
9520 value_free (bp->val);
9521 bp->val = NULL;
9522 bp->val_valid = 0;
9523 }
9524 }
9525 }
9526
9527 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9528
9529 struct symtabs_and_lines
9530 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9531 {
9532 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9533 if (string == 0)
9534 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9535 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9536 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9537 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9538 default_breakpoint_line,
9539 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9540 else
9541 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9542 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9543 if (*string)
9544 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9545 return sals;
9546 }
9547
9548 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9549 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9550 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9551 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9552 someday. */
9553
9554 void *
9555 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9556 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9557 {
9558 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9559
9560 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9561
9562 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9563 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9564
9565 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9566 {
9567 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9568 xfree (bp_tgt);
9569 return NULL;
9570 }
9571
9572 return bp_tgt;
9573 }
9574
9575 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9576
9577 int
9578 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9579 {
9580 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9581 int ret;
9582
9583 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9584 xfree (bp_tgt);
9585
9586 return ret;
9587 }
9588
9589 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9590
9591 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9592 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9593
9594 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9595
9596 void
9597 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9598 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9599 {
9600 void **bpt_p;
9601
9602 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9603 {
9604 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9605 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9606 }
9607 else
9608 {
9609 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9610 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9611 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9612 }
9613
9614 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9615 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9616 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9617 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9618 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9619 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9620
9621 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9622 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9623 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9624 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9625 }
9626
9627 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9628
9629 void
9630 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9631 {
9632 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9633
9634 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9635 call. */
9636 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9637 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9638 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9639 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9640
9641 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9642 {
9643 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9644 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9645 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9646 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9647 }
9648 }
9649
9650 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9651
9652 static int
9653 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9654 {
9655 int i;
9656
9657 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9658 {
9659 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9660 if (bp_tgt
9661 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9662 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9663 aspace, pc))
9664 return 1;
9665 }
9666
9667 return 0;
9668 }
9669
9670 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9671 non-zero otherwise. */
9672 static int
9673 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9674 {
9675 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9676 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9677 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9678 return 1;
9679 else
9680 return 0;
9681 }
9682
9683 int
9684 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9685 {
9686 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9687
9688 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9689 }
9690
9691 int
9692 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9693 {
9694 struct breakpoint *bp;
9695
9696 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9697 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9698 {
9699 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9700 {
9701 int i, iter;
9702 for (i = 0;
9703 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9704 i++)
9705 if (syscall_number == iter)
9706 return 1;
9707 }
9708 else
9709 return 1;
9710 }
9711
9712 return 0;
9713 }
9714
9715 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9716 static char **
9717 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9718 char *text, char *word)
9719 {
9720 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9721 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9722 }
9723
9724 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
9725
9726 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
9727 static void
9728 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
9729 {
9730 tracepoint_count = num;
9731 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
9732 }
9733
9734 void
9735 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9736 {
9737 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9738 arg,
9739 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9740 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
9741 1 /* traceflag */,
9742 0 /* Ignore count */,
9743 pending_break_support,
9744 NULL,
9745 from_tty,
9746 1 /* enabled */);
9747 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9748 }
9749
9750 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
9751 omitted. */
9752
9753 static void
9754 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
9755 {
9756 struct breakpoint *b;
9757 int tps_to_list = 0;
9758
9759 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
9760 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
9761 {
9762 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9763 {
9764 if (b->number >= 0)
9765 {
9766 tps_to_list = 1;
9767 break;
9768 }
9769 }
9770 if (!tps_to_list)
9771 {
9772 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
9773 return;
9774 }
9775 }
9776
9777 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
9778 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
9779 }
9780
9781 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
9782 Not supported by all targets. */
9783 static void
9784 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9785 {
9786 enable_command (args, from_tty);
9787 }
9788
9789 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
9790 Not supported by all targets. */
9791 static void
9792 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9793 {
9794 disable_command (args, from_tty);
9795 }
9796
9797 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
9798 static void
9799 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9800 {
9801 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9802
9803 dont_repeat ();
9804
9805 if (arg == 0)
9806 {
9807 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9808
9809 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9810 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9811 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9812 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9813 {
9814 if (b->number >= 0)
9815 {
9816 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9817 break;
9818 }
9819 }
9820
9821 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9822 if (!from_tty
9823 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
9824 {
9825 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9826 {
9827 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint
9828 && b->number >= 0)
9829 delete_breakpoint (b);
9830 }
9831 }
9832 }
9833 else
9834 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9835 }
9836
9837 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
9838
9839 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
9840 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
9841 Also accepts special argument "all". */
9842
9843 static void
9844 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9845 {
9846 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
9847 unsigned int count;
9848 int all = 0;
9849
9850 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9851 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
9852
9853 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
9854
9855 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
9856 args++;
9857
9858 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
9859 {
9860 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
9861 all = 1;
9862 if (*args)
9863 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9864 }
9865 else
9866 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
9867
9868 do
9869 {
9870 if (t1)
9871 {
9872 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
9873 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
9874 {
9875 t2->pass_count = count;
9876 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
9877 if (from_tty)
9878 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
9879 t2->number, count);
9880 }
9881 if (! all && *args)
9882 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
9883 }
9884 }
9885 while (*args);
9886 }
9887
9888 struct breakpoint *
9889 get_tracepoint (int num)
9890 {
9891 struct breakpoint *t;
9892
9893 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9894 if (t->number == num)
9895 return t;
9896
9897 return NULL;
9898 }
9899
9900 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
9901 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
9902 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
9903 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
9904 struct breakpoint *
9905 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
9906 {
9907 extern int tracepoint_count;
9908 struct breakpoint *t;
9909 int tpnum;
9910 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
9911
9912 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
9913 {
9914 if (optional_p)
9915 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
9916 else
9917 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
9918 }
9919 else
9920 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
9921
9922 if (tpnum <= 0)
9923 {
9924 if (instring && *instring)
9925 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
9926 instring);
9927 else
9928 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
9929 return NULL;
9930 }
9931
9932 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9933 if (t->number == tpnum)
9934 {
9935 return t;
9936 }
9937
9938 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
9939 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
9940 allow us to discover this. */
9941 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
9942 return NULL;
9943 }
9944
9945 /* save-tracepoints command */
9946 static void
9947 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9948 {
9949 struct breakpoint *tp;
9950 int any_tp = 0;
9951 struct action_line *line;
9952 FILE *fp;
9953 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
9954 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
9955 char tmp[40];
9956 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9957
9958 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9959 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
9960
9961 /* See if we have anything to save. */
9962 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9963 {
9964 any_tp = 1;
9965 break;
9966 }
9967 if (!any_tp)
9968 {
9969 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
9970 return;
9971 }
9972
9973 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
9974 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
9975 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
9976 if (!fp)
9977 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
9978 args, safe_strerror (errno));
9979 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
9980
9981 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9982 {
9983 if (tp->addr_string)
9984 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
9985 else
9986 {
9987 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
9988 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
9989 }
9990
9991 if (tp->pass_count)
9992 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
9993
9994 if (tp->actions)
9995 {
9996 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
9997 indent = i1;
9998 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
9999 {
10000 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10001
10002 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10003 actionline = line->action;
10004 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10005 actionline++;
10006
10007 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10008 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10009 {
10010 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10011 if (cmd == 0)
10012 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10013 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10014 indent = i2;
10015 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10016 indent = i1;
10017 }
10018 }
10019 }
10020 }
10021 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10022 if (from_tty)
10023 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10024 return;
10025 }
10026
10027 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10028
10029 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10030 all_tracepoints ()
10031 {
10032 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10033 struct breakpoint *tp;
10034
10035 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10036 {
10037 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10038 }
10039
10040 return tp_vec;
10041 }
10042
10043 \f
10044 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10045 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10046 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10047 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10048 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10049 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10050 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10051 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10052 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10053 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10054 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10055 \n\
10056 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10057 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10058 \n\
10059 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10060 \n\
10061 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10062
10063 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10064 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10065
10066 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10067 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10068
10069 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10070 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10071 static void
10072 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10073 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10074 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10075 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10076 char *text, char *word),
10077 void *user_data_catch,
10078 void *user_data_tcatch)
10079 {
10080 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10081
10082 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10083 &catch_cmdlist);
10084 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10085 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10086 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10087
10088 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10089 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10090 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10091 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10092 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10093 }
10094
10095 static void
10096 clear_syscall_counts (int pid)
10097 {
10098 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
10099
10100 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10101 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10102 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10103 }
10104
10105 void
10106 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10107 {
10108 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10109 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10110 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10111
10112 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10113 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10114 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10115
10116 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10117 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10118 before a breakpoint is set. */
10119 breakpoint_count = 0;
10120
10121 tracepoint_count = 0;
10122
10123 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10124 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10125 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10126 if (xdb_commands)
10127 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10128
10129 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10130 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10131 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10132 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10133 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10134 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10135 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10136 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10137
10138 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10139 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10140 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10141 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10142
10143 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10144 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10145 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10146 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10147 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10148 \n"
10149 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10150 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10151
10152 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10153 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10154 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10155 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10156 \n"
10157 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10158 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10159
10160 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10161 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10162 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10163 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10164 \n"
10165 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10166 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10167
10168 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10169 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10170 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10171 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10172 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10173 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10174 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10175 if (xdb_commands)
10176 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10177 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10178 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10179 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10180 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10181 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10182
10183 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10184
10185 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10186 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10187 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10188 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10189 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10190 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10191
10192 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10193 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10194 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10195 &enablebreaklist);
10196
10197 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10198 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10199 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10200 &enablebreaklist);
10201
10202 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10203 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10204 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10205 &enablelist);
10206
10207 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10208 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10209 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10210 &enablelist);
10211
10212 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10213 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10214 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10215 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10216 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10217 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10218 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10219 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10220 if (xdb_commands)
10221 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10222 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10223 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10224 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10225 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10226
10227 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10228 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10229 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10230 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10231 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10232 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10233 &disablelist);
10234
10235 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10236 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10237 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10238 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10239 \n\
10240 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10241 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10242 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10243 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10244 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10245 if (xdb_commands)
10246 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10247 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10248 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10249 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10250
10251 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10252 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10253 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10254 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10255 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10256 &deletelist);
10257
10258 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10259 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10260 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10261 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10262 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10263 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10264 \n\
10265 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10266 is executing in.\n\
10267 \n\
10268 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10269
10270 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10271 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10272 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10273 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10274
10275 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10276 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10277 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10278 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10279
10280 if (xdb_commands)
10281 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10282
10283 if (dbx_commands)
10284 {
10285 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10286 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10287 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10288 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10289 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10290 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10291 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10292 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10293 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10294 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10295 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10296 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10297 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10298 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10299 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10300 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10301 \n\
10302 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10303 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10304 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10305 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10306 breakpoint set."));
10307 }
10308
10309 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10310 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10311 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10312 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10313 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10314 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10315 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10316 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10317 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10318 \n\
10319 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10320 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10321 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10322 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10323 breakpoint set."));
10324
10325 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10326
10327 if (xdb_commands)
10328 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10329 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10330 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10331 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10332 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10333 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10334 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10335 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10336 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10337 \n\
10338 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10339 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10340 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10341 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10342 breakpoint set."));
10343
10344 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10345 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10346 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10347 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10348 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10349 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10350 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10351 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10352 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10353 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10354 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10355 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10356 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10357 \n\
10358 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10359 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10360 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10361 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10362 breakpoint set."),
10363 &maintenanceinfolist);
10364
10365 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10366 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10367 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10368 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10369
10370 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10371 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10372 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10373 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10374
10375 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10376 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10377 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10378 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10379 catch_catch_command,
10380 NULL,
10381 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10382 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10383 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10384 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10385 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10386 catch_throw_command,
10387 NULL,
10388 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10389 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10390 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10391 catch_fork_command_1,
10392 NULL,
10393 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10394 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10395 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10396 catch_fork_command_1,
10397 NULL,
10398 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10399 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10400 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10401 catch_exec_command_1,
10402 NULL,
10403 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10404 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10405 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10406 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10407 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10408 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10409 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10410 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10411 catch_syscall_command_1,
10412 catch_syscall_completer,
10413 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10414 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10415 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10416 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10417 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10418 catch_ada_exception_command,
10419 NULL,
10420 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10421 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10422 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10423 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10424 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10425 catch_assert_command,
10426 NULL,
10427 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10428 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10429
10430 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10431 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10432 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10433 an expression changes."));
10434 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10435
10436 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10437 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10438 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10439 an expression is read."));
10440 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10441
10442 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10443 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10444 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10445 an expression is either read or written."));
10446 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10447
10448 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10449 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10450
10451
10452 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10453 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10454 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10455 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10456 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10457 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10458 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10459 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10460 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10461 hardware.)"),
10462 NULL,
10463 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10464 &setlist, &showlist);
10465
10466 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10467
10468 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10469
10470 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10471 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10472 \n"
10473 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10474 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10475 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10476
10477 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10478 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10479 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10480 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10481
10482 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10483 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10484 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10485 last tracepoint set."));
10486
10487 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10488
10489 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10490 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10491 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10492 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10493 &deletelist);
10494
10495 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10496 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10497 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10498 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10499 &disablelist);
10500 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10501
10502 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10503 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10504 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10505 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10506 &enablelist);
10507 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10508
10509 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10510 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10511 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10512 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10513 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10514
10515 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10516 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10517 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10518 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10519
10520 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10521 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10522 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10523 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10524 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10525 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10526 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10527 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10528 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10529 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10530 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10531 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10532
10533 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10534 &pending_break_support, _("\
10535 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10536 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10537 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10538 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10539 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10540 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10541 NULL,
10542 show_pending_break_support,
10543 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10544 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10545
10546 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10547
10548 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10549 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10550 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10551 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10552 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10553 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10554 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10555 NULL,
10556 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10557 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10558 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10559
10560 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10561 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10562 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10563 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10564 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10565 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10566 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10567 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10568 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10569 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10570 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10571 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10572 NULL,
10573 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10574 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10575 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10576
10577 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10578
10579 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10580 }